| /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB. | 
 |  | 
 |    Copyright (C) 1986-2025 Free Software Foundation, Inc. | 
 |  | 
 |    This file is part of GDB. | 
 |  | 
 |    This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify | 
 |    it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by | 
 |    the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or | 
 |    (at your option) any later version. | 
 |  | 
 |    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, | 
 |    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of | 
 |    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the | 
 |    GNU General Public License for more details. | 
 |  | 
 |    You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License | 
 |    along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | #include "arch-utils.h" | 
 | #include "event-top.h" | 
 | #include "exceptions.h" | 
 | #include "gdbsupport/gdb_vecs.h" | 
 | #include "gdbsupport/unordered_set.h" | 
 | #include "symtab.h" | 
 | #include "frame.h" | 
 | #include "breakpoint.h" | 
 | #include "tracepoint.h" | 
 | #include "gdbtypes.h" | 
 | #include "expression.h" | 
 | #include "gdbcore.h" | 
 | #include "cli/cli-cmds.h" | 
 | #include "value.h" | 
 | #include "command.h" | 
 | #include "inferior.h" | 
 | #include "infrun.h" | 
 | #include "gdbthread.h" | 
 | #include "target.h" | 
 | #include "language.h" | 
 | #include "gdb-demangle.h" | 
 | #include "filenames.h" | 
 | #include "annotate.h" | 
 | #include "symfile.h" | 
 | #include "objfiles.h" | 
 | #include "source.h" | 
 | #include "linespec.h" | 
 | #include "completer.h" | 
 | #include "ui-out.h" | 
 | #include "cli/cli-script.h" | 
 | #include "block.h" | 
 | #include "solib.h" | 
 | #include "observable.h" | 
 | #include "memattr.h" | 
 | #include "ada-lang.h" | 
 | #include "top.h" | 
 | #include "ui.h" | 
 | #include "valprint.h" | 
 | #include "jit.h" | 
 | #include "parser-defs.h" | 
 | #include "probe.h" | 
 | #include "cli/cli-utils.h" | 
 | #include "stack.h" | 
 | #include "ax-gdb.h" | 
 | #include "dummy-frame.h" | 
 | #include "interps.h" | 
 | #include "gdbsupport/format.h" | 
 | #include "thread-fsm.h" | 
 | #include "tid-parse.h" | 
 | #include "cli/cli-style.h" | 
 | #include "cli/cli-decode.h" | 
 | #include "break-cond-parse.h" | 
 |  | 
 | /* readline include files */ | 
 | #include "readline/tilde.h" | 
 |  | 
 | /* readline defines this.  */ | 
 | #undef savestring | 
 |  | 
 | #include "mi/mi-common.h" | 
 | #include "extension.h" | 
 | #include <algorithm> | 
 | #include "progspace-and-thread.h" | 
 | #include "gdbsupport/array-view.h" | 
 | #include <optional> | 
 | #include "gdbsupport/common-utils.h" | 
 |  | 
 | /* Prototypes for local functions.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *, | 
 | 				    gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)>); | 
 |  | 
 | static void parse_breakpoint_sals (location_spec *locspec, | 
 | 				   linespec_result *canonical, | 
 | 				   program_space *search_pspace); | 
 |  | 
 | static void breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b, | 
 | 				   program_space *filter_pspace); | 
 |  | 
 | static void create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *, | 
 | 				    struct linespec_result *, | 
 | 				    gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>, | 
 | 				    gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>, | 
 | 				    enum bptype, | 
 | 				    enum bpdisp, int, int, int, | 
 | 				    int, | 
 | 				    int, int, int, unsigned); | 
 |  | 
 | static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint | 
 |     (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals); | 
 |  | 
 | static void mention (const breakpoint *); | 
 |  | 
 | static breakpoint *add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b); | 
 |  | 
 | static breakpoint *add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b); | 
 |  | 
 | static struct breakpoint * | 
 |   momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig, | 
 | 				    enum bptype type, | 
 | 				    int loc_enabled, int thread); | 
 |  | 
 | static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, bool); | 
 |  | 
 | static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
 | 					    CORE_ADDR bpaddr, | 
 | 					    enum bptype bptype, | 
 | 					    struct program_space *pspace); | 
 |  | 
 | static bool watchpoint_locations_match (const struct bp_location *loc1, | 
 | 					const struct bp_location *loc2); | 
 |  | 
 | static bool breakpoint_locations_match (const struct bp_location *loc1, | 
 | 					const struct bp_location *loc2, | 
 | 					bool sw_hw_bps_match = false); | 
 |  | 
 | static bool breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 					       const struct address_space *aspace, | 
 | 					       CORE_ADDR addr); | 
 |  | 
 | static bool breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *, | 
 | 						       const address_space *, | 
 | 						       CORE_ADDR, int); | 
 |  | 
 | static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *); | 
 | static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason); | 
 |  | 
 | static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat *bs); | 
 |  | 
 | static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void); | 
 |  | 
 | static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *); | 
 |  | 
 | static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except, | 
 | 					    enum bptype type, | 
 | 					    int *other_type_used); | 
 |  | 
 | static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp, | 
 | 				    int count); | 
 |  | 
 | static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc); | 
 |  | 
 | static std::vector<symtab_and_line> bkpt_probe_decode_location_spec | 
 |      (struct breakpoint *b, | 
 |       location_spec *locspec, | 
 |       struct program_space *search_pspace); | 
 |  | 
 | static bool bl_address_is_meaningful (const bp_location *loc); | 
 |  | 
 | static int find_loc_num_by_location (const bp_location *loc); | 
 |  | 
 | /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to | 
 |    insert locations now.  */ | 
 | enum ugll_insert_mode | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only | 
 |      remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be | 
 |      inserted.  Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints | 
 |      should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't | 
 |      have the side effect of inserting the locations of other | 
 |      breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted | 
 |      returns true on them. | 
 |  | 
 |      This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g., | 
 |      after an exec, while the target still has execution, but | 
 |      breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* | 
 |      be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the | 
 |      target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from | 
 |      GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from | 
 |      the inferior.  */ | 
 |   UGLL_DONT_INSERT, | 
 |  | 
 |   /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now | 
 |      claims breakpoints should be inserted now.  */ | 
 |   UGLL_MAY_INSERT, | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Insert locations now, irrespective of | 
 |      breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now.  E.g., say all threads are | 
 |      stopped right now, and the user did "continue".  We need to | 
 |      insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but | 
 |      UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because | 
 |      breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point, | 
 |      as no thread is running yet.  */ | 
 |   UGLL_INSERT | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return a textual version of INSERT_MODE.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static const char * | 
 | ugll_insert_mode_text (ugll_insert_mode insert_mode) | 
 | { | 
 | /* Make sure the compiler warns if a new ugll_insert_mode enumerator is added | 
 |    but not handled here.  */ | 
 | DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH | 
 | DIAGNOSTIC_ERROR_SWITCH | 
 |   switch (insert_mode) | 
 |     { | 
 |     case UGLL_DONT_INSERT: | 
 |       return "UGLL_DONT_INSERT"; | 
 |     case UGLL_MAY_INSERT: | 
 |       return "UGLL_MAY_INSERT"; | 
 |     case UGLL_INSERT: | 
 |       return "UGLL_INSERT"; | 
 |     } | 
 | DIAGNOSTIC_POP | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_assert_not_reached ("must handle all enum values"); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return a textual version of REASON.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static const char * | 
 | remove_bp_reason_str (remove_bp_reason reason) | 
 | { | 
 | /* Make sure the compiler warns if a new remove_bp_reason enumerator is added | 
 |    but not handled here.  */ | 
 | DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH | 
 | DIAGNOSTIC_ERROR_SWITCH | 
 |   switch (reason) | 
 |     { | 
 |     case REMOVE_BREAKPOINT: | 
 |       return "regular remove"; | 
 |     case DETACH_BREAKPOINT: | 
 |       return "detach"; | 
 |     } | 
 | DIAGNOSTIC_POP | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_assert_not_reached ("must handle all enum values"); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return a textual version of breakpoint location BL describing number, | 
 |    location and address.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static std::string | 
 | breakpoint_location_address_str (const bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   std::string str = string_printf ("Breakpoint %d (%s) ", | 
 | 				   bl->owner->number, | 
 | 				   host_address_to_string (bl)); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bl_address_is_meaningful (bl)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       gdb_assert (bl->gdbarch != nullptr); | 
 |       str += string_printf ("at address %s", | 
 | 			    paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address)); | 
 |  | 
 |       std::string loc_string = bl->to_string (); | 
 |       if (!loc_string.empty ()) | 
 | 	str += string_printf (" %s", loc_string.c_str ()); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     str += "with dummy location"; | 
 |  | 
 |   return str; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode); | 
 |  | 
 | static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode); | 
 |  | 
 | static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void); | 
 |  | 
 | static void trace_pass_command (const char *, int); | 
 |  | 
 | static void set_tracepoint_count (int num); | 
 |  | 
 | static bool is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b); | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return true if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), | 
 |    zero otherwise.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b); | 
 |  | 
 | static void bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location_spec | 
 |      (location_spec *locspec, | 
 |       struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
 |       struct program_space *search_pspace); | 
 |  | 
 | const struct breakpoint_ops code_breakpoint_ops = | 
 | { | 
 |   parse_breakpoint_sals, | 
 |   create_breakpoints_sal, | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Breakpoints set on probes.  */ | 
 | static const struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops = | 
 | { | 
 |   bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location_spec, | 
 |   create_breakpoints_sal, | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Tracepoints set on probes.  We use the same methods as for breakpoints | 
 |    on probes.  */ | 
 | static const struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops = | 
 | { | 
 |   bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location_spec, | 
 |   create_breakpoints_sal, | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implementation of abstract dtors.  These must exist to satisfy the | 
 |    linker.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | breakpoint::~breakpoint () | 
 | { | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | code_breakpoint::~code_breakpoint () | 
 | { | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | catchpoint::~catchpoint () | 
 | { | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* The structure to be used in regular breakpoints.  */ | 
 | struct ordinary_breakpoint : public code_breakpoint | 
 | { | 
 |   using code_breakpoint::code_breakpoint; | 
 |  | 
 |   int resources_needed (const struct bp_location *) override; | 
 |   enum print_stop_action print_it (const bpstat *bs) const override; | 
 |   void print_mention () const override; | 
 |   void print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const override; | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Internal breakpoints.  These typically have a lifetime the same as | 
 |    the program, and they end up installed on the breakpoint chain with | 
 |    a negative breakpoint number.  They're visible in "maint info | 
 |    breakpoints", but not "info breakpoints".  */ | 
 | struct internal_breakpoint : public code_breakpoint | 
 | { | 
 |   internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
 | 		       enum bptype type, CORE_ADDR address) | 
 |     : code_breakpoint (gdbarch, type) | 
 |   { | 
 |     symtab_and_line sal; | 
 |     sal.pc = address; | 
 |     sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc); | 
 |     sal.pspace = current_program_space; | 
 |     add_location (sal); | 
 |  | 
 |     pspace = current_program_space; | 
 |     disposition = disp_donttouch; | 
 |   } | 
 |  | 
 |   void re_set (program_space *pspace) override; | 
 |   void check_status (struct bpstat *bs) override; | 
 |   enum print_stop_action print_it (const bpstat *bs) const override; | 
 |   void print_mention () const override; | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Momentary breakpoints.  These typically have a lifetime of some run | 
 |    control command only, are always thread-specific, and have 0 for | 
 |    breakpoint number.  I.e., there can be many momentary breakpoints | 
 |    on the breakpoint chain and they all same the same number (zero). | 
 |    They're visible in "maint info breakpoints", but not "info | 
 |    breakpoints".  */ | 
 | struct momentary_breakpoint : public code_breakpoint | 
 | { | 
 |   momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch_, enum bptype bptype, | 
 | 			program_space *pspace_, | 
 | 			const struct frame_id &frame_id_, | 
 | 			int thread_) | 
 |     : code_breakpoint (gdbarch_, bptype) | 
 |   { | 
 |     /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined | 
 |        or tail-called one.  */ | 
 |     gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id)); | 
 |  | 
 |     /* Momentary breakpoints are always thread-specific.  */ | 
 |     gdb_assert (thread_ > 0); | 
 |  | 
 |     pspace = pspace_; | 
 |     enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
 |     disposition = disp_donttouch; | 
 |     frame_id = frame_id_; | 
 |     thread = thread_; | 
 |  | 
 |     /* The inferior should have been set by the parent constructor.  */ | 
 |     gdb_assert (inferior == -1); | 
 |   } | 
 |  | 
 |   void re_set (program_space *pspace) override; | 
 |   void check_status (struct bpstat *bs) override; | 
 |   enum print_stop_action print_it (const bpstat *bs) const override; | 
 |   void print_mention () const override; | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* DPrintf breakpoints.  */ | 
 | struct dprintf_breakpoint : public ordinary_breakpoint | 
 | { | 
 |   using ordinary_breakpoint::ordinary_breakpoint; | 
 |  | 
 |   void re_set (program_space *pspace) override; | 
 |   int breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 		      const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 		      CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
 | 		      const target_waitstatus &ws) override; | 
 |   void print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const override; | 
 |   void after_condition_true (struct bpstat *bs) override; | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
 | struct ranged_breakpoint : public ordinary_breakpoint | 
 | { | 
 |   explicit ranged_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
 | 			      const symtab_and_line &sal_start, | 
 | 			      int length, | 
 | 			      location_spec_up start_locspec, | 
 | 			      location_spec_up end_locspec) | 
 |     : ordinary_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 |   { | 
 |     bp_location *bl = add_location (sal_start); | 
 |     bl->length = length; | 
 |  | 
 |     disposition = disp_donttouch; | 
 |  | 
 |     locspec = std::move (start_locspec); | 
 |     locspec_range_end = std::move (end_locspec); | 
 |   } | 
 |  | 
 |   int breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 		      const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 		      CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
 | 		      const target_waitstatus &ws) override; | 
 |   int resources_needed (const struct bp_location *) override; | 
 |   enum print_stop_action print_it (const bpstat *bs) const override; | 
 |   bool print_one (const bp_location **) const override; | 
 |   void print_one_detail (struct ui_out *) const override; | 
 |   void print_mention () const override; | 
 |   void print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const override; | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m').  */ | 
 | struct static_marker_tracepoint : public tracepoint | 
 | { | 
 |   using tracepoint::tracepoint; | 
 |  | 
 |   std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location_spec | 
 |        (struct location_spec *locspec, | 
 | 	struct program_space *search_pspace) override; | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf.  This is a user | 
 |    option because different output options have different tradeoffs; | 
 |    if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there | 
 |    is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior | 
 |    function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of | 
 |    output to the same place as compiled-in print functions.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb"; | 
 | static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call"; | 
 | static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent"; | 
 | static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = { | 
 |   dprintf_style_gdb, | 
 |   dprintf_style_call, | 
 |   dprintf_style_agent, | 
 |   NULL | 
 | }; | 
 | static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb; | 
 |  | 
 | /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to | 
 |    call into the inferior.  The value is simply a string that is | 
 |    copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can | 
 |    evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static std::string dprintf_function = "printf"; | 
 |  | 
 | /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to | 
 |    call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to | 
 |    the call as the first argument, with the format string as the | 
 |    second.  As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that | 
 |    GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like | 
 |    "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like | 
 |    "mystreams[curlogger]".  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static std::string dprintf_channel; | 
 |  | 
 | /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB | 
 |    has disconnected.  */ | 
 | static bool disconnected_dprintf = true; | 
 |  | 
 | struct command_line * | 
 | breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   return b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the | 
 |    current breakpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool breakpoint_proceeded; | 
 |  | 
 | const char * | 
 | bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and | 
 |      represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at | 
 |      a breakpoint.  */ | 
 |   static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"}; | 
 |  | 
 |   return bpdisps[(int) disp]; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Prototypes for exported functions.  */ | 
 | /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even | 
 |    if such is available.  */ | 
 | static int can_use_hw_watchpoints; | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | 
 | 			     struct cmd_list_element *c, | 
 | 			     const char *value) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_printf (file, | 
 | 	      _("Debugger's willingness to use " | 
 | 		"watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"), | 
 | 	      value); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints. | 
 |    If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints | 
 |    for unrecognized breakpoint locations. | 
 |    If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized.  */ | 
 | static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support; | 
 | static void | 
 | show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | 
 | 			    struct cmd_list_element *c, | 
 | 			    const char *value) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_printf (file, | 
 | 	      _("Debugger's behavior regarding " | 
 | 		"pending breakpoints is %s.\n"), | 
 | 	      value); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* If true, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints | 
 |    set with "break" but falling in read-only memory. | 
 |    If false, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically | 
 |    use hardware breakpoints.  */ | 
 | static bool automatic_hardware_breakpoints; | 
 | static void | 
 | show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | 
 | 				     struct cmd_list_element *c, | 
 | 				     const char *value) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_printf (file, | 
 | 	      _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"), | 
 | 	      value); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is | 
 |    stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as | 
 |    they're created.  If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of | 
 |    the target as long as possible.  That is, it delays inserting | 
 |    breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the | 
 |    target fully stops.  This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while | 
 |    processing user input.  */ | 
 | static bool always_inserted_mode = false; | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | 
 | 		     struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_printf (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), | 
 | 	      value); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 | bool debug_breakpoint = false; | 
 |  | 
 | /* "show debug breakpoint" implementation.  */ | 
 | static void | 
 | show_debug_breakpoint (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | 
 | 		       struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_printf (file, _("Breakpoint location debugging is %s.\n"), value); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (current_inferior ()->arch ())) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no | 
 | 	 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are | 
 | 	 no threads under GDB's control yet.  */ | 
 |       return 1; | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (always_inserted_mode) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads | 
 | 	     are stopped.  */ | 
 | 	  return 1; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ()) | 
 | 	if (inf->has_execution () | 
 | 	    && threads_are_executing (inf->process_target ())) | 
 | 	  return 1; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are | 
 | 	 stopped, we still have events to process.  */ | 
 |       for (thread_info &tp : all_non_exited_threads ()) | 
 | 	if (tp.resumed () && tp.has_pending_waitstatus ()) | 
 | 	  return 1; | 
 |     } | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target"; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation.  */ | 
 | static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto"; | 
 | static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host"; | 
 | static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target"; | 
 | static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = { | 
 |   condition_evaluation_auto, | 
 |   condition_evaluation_host, | 
 |   condition_evaluation_target, | 
 |   NULL | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation.  */ | 
 | static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from | 
 |    condition_evaluation_mode_1.  */ | 
 | static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host" | 
 |    or "target".  This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the | 
 |    real setting that is being used.  It returns the translated | 
 |    evaluation mode.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static const char * | 
 | translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
 | 	return condition_evaluation_target; | 
 |       else | 
 | 	return condition_evaluation_host; | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     return mode; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static const char * | 
 | breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false | 
 |    otherwise.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (); | 
 |  | 
 |   return (mode == condition_evaluation_host); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Are we executing breakpoint commands?  */ | 
 | static int executing_breakpoint_commands; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */ | 
 | static int overlay_events_enabled; | 
 |  | 
 | /* See description in breakpoint.h. */ | 
 | bool target_exact_watchpoints = false; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Chains of all breakpoints defined.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static intrusive_list<breakpoint> breakpoint_chain; | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | breakpoint_range | 
 | all_breakpoints () | 
 | { | 
 |   return breakpoint_range (breakpoint_chain.begin (), breakpoint_chain.end ()); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | breakpoint_safe_range | 
 | all_breakpoints_safe () | 
 | { | 
 |   return breakpoint_safe_range (all_breakpoints ()); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | tracepoint_range | 
 | all_tracepoints () | 
 | { | 
 |   breakpoint_iterator begin (breakpoint_chain.begin ()); | 
 |   breakpoint_iterator end (breakpoint_chain.end ()); | 
 |   tracepoint_iterator tracepoint_begin (std::move (begin), end); | 
 |   tracepoint_iterator tracepoint_end (end, end); | 
 |  | 
 |   return tracepoint_range (std::move (tracepoint_begin), | 
 | 			   std::move (tracepoint_end)); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Array is sorted by bp_location_ptr_is_less_than - primarily by the | 
 |    ADDRESS.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static std::vector<bp_location *> bp_locations; | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | const std::vector<bp_location *> & | 
 | all_bp_locations () | 
 | { | 
 |   return bp_locations; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Range to iterate over breakpoint locations at a given address.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | struct bp_locations_at_addr_range | 
 | { | 
 |   using iterator = std::vector<bp_location *>::iterator; | 
 |  | 
 |   bp_locations_at_addr_range (CORE_ADDR addr) | 
 |   { | 
 |     struct compare | 
 |     { | 
 |       bool operator() (const bp_location *loc, CORE_ADDR addr_) const | 
 |       { return loc->address < addr_; } | 
 |  | 
 |       bool operator() (CORE_ADDR addr_, const bp_location *loc) const | 
 |       { return addr_ < loc->address; } | 
 |     }; | 
 |  | 
 |     auto it_pair = std::equal_range (bp_locations.begin (), bp_locations.end (), | 
 | 				     addr, compare ()); | 
 |  | 
 |     m_begin = it_pair.first; | 
 |     m_end = it_pair.second; | 
 |   } | 
 |  | 
 |   iterator begin () const | 
 |   { return m_begin; } | 
 |  | 
 |   iterator end () const | 
 |   { return m_end; } | 
 |  | 
 | private: | 
 |   iterator m_begin; | 
 |   iterator m_end; | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return a range to iterate over all breakpoint locations exactly at address | 
 |    ADDR. | 
 |  | 
 |    If it's needed to iterate multiple times on the same range, it's possible | 
 |    to save the range in a local variable and use it multiple times: | 
 |  | 
 |      auto range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (addr); | 
 |  | 
 |      for (bp_location *loc : range) | 
 |        // use loc | 
 |  | 
 |      for (bp_location *loc : range) | 
 |        // use loc | 
 |  | 
 |    This saves a bit of time, as it avoids re-doing the binary searches to find | 
 |    the range's boundaries.  Just remember not to change the bp_locations vector | 
 |    in the mean time, as it could make the range's iterators stale.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bp_locations_at_addr_range | 
 | all_bp_locations_at_addr (CORE_ADDR addr) | 
 | { | 
 |   return bp_locations_at_addr_range (addr); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and | 
 |    ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid | 
 |    result from bp_location_has_shadow.  You can use it for roughly | 
 |    limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for | 
 |    an address you need to read.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS | 
 |    + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of | 
 |    BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow. | 
 |    You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to | 
 |    scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max; | 
 |  | 
 | /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked | 
 |    from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be | 
 |    reported by a target.  */ | 
 | static std::vector<bp_location *> moribund_locations; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Number of last breakpoint made.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static int breakpoint_count; | 
 |  | 
 | /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that | 
 |    created breakpoints.  If the last (break-like) command created more | 
 |    than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT | 
 |    and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one.  */ | 
 | static int prev_breakpoint_count; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Number of last tracepoint made.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static int tracepoint_count; | 
 |  | 
 | static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist; | 
 | static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist; | 
 | struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint.  */ | 
 | static bool | 
 | breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Set breakpoint count to NUM.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | set_breakpoint_count (int num) | 
 | { | 
 |   prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count; | 
 |   breakpoint_count = num; | 
 |   set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current | 
 |    breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint.  */ | 
 | static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first | 
 |    breakpoint made.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints () | 
 | { | 
 |   rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last | 
 |    breakpoint made.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints () | 
 | { | 
 |   prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::first_breakpoint () const | 
 | { | 
 |   return rbreak_start_breakpoint_count + 1; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::last_breakpoint () const | 
 | { | 
 |   return (rbreak_start_breakpoint_count == breakpoint_count | 
 | 	  ? -1 | 
 | 	  : breakpoint_count); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     b.hit_count = 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL | 
 |    if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | struct breakpoint * | 
 | get_breakpoint (int num) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (b.number == num) | 
 |       return &b; | 
 |    | 
 |   return nullptr; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return TRUE if NUM refer to an existing breakpoint that has | 
 |    multiple code locations.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | has_multiple_locations (int num) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (b.number == num) | 
 |       return b.has_multiple_locations (); | 
 |  | 
 |   return false; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 | /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports | 
 |    evaluating conditions on its side.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* This is only meaningful if the target is | 
 |      evaluating conditions and if the user has | 
 |      opted for condition evaluation on the target's | 
 |      side.  */ | 
 |   if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | 
 |       || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!is_breakpoint (b)) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | 
 |     loc.condition_changed = condition_modified; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports | 
 |    evaluating conditions on its side.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* This is only meaningful if the target is | 
 |      evaluating conditions and if the user has | 
 |      opted for condition evaluation on the target's | 
 |      side.  */ | 
 |   if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | 
 |       || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
 |  | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   loc->condition_changed = condition_modified; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global | 
 |    condition_evaluation_mode.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | set_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *args, int from_tty, | 
 | 			       struct cmd_list_element *c) | 
 | { | 
 |   const char *old_mode, *new_mode; | 
 |  | 
 |   if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target) | 
 |       && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode; | 
 |       warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n" | 
 | 		 "Using host evaluation mode instead.")); | 
 |       return; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1); | 
 |   old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Flip the switch.  Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the | 
 |      settings was "auto".  */ | 
 |   condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one.  */ | 
 |   if (new_mode != old_mode) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we | 
 | 	 need to synch the changes with the target as follows: | 
 |  | 
 | 	 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target. | 
 | 	 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target. | 
 |       */ | 
 |  | 
 |       if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the | 
 | 	     target.  */ | 
 | 	  for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 | 	    mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions | 
 | 	     with the target.  We do this to remove all the conditions the | 
 | 	     target knows about.  */ | 
 | 	  for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 | 	    if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted) | 
 | 	      loc->needs_update = 1; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Do the update.  */ | 
 |       update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation.  Explicitly shows | 
 |    what "auto" is translating to.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | 
 | 				struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto) | 
 |     gdb_printf (file, | 
 | 		_("Breakpoint condition evaluation " | 
 | 		  "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"), | 
 | 		value, | 
 | 		breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()); | 
 |   else | 
 |     gdb_printf (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"), | 
 | 		value); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Parse COND_STRING in the context of LOC and set as the condition | 
 |    expression of LOC.  BP_NUM is the number of LOC's owner, LOC_NUM is | 
 |    the number of LOC within its owner.  In case of parsing error, mark | 
 |    LOC as DISABLED_BY_COND.  In case of success, unset DISABLED_BY_COND.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | set_breakpoint_location_condition (const char *cond_string, bp_location *loc, | 
 | 				   int bp_num, int loc_num) | 
 | { | 
 |   bool has_junk = false; | 
 |   try | 
 |     { | 
 |       expression_up new_exp = parse_exp_1 (&cond_string, loc->address, | 
 | 					   block_for_pc (loc->address), 0); | 
 |       if (*cond_string != 0) | 
 | 	has_junk = true; | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  loc->cond = std::move (new_exp); | 
 | 	  if (loc->disabled_by_cond && loc->enabled) | 
 | 	    gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is now valid at " | 
 | 			  "location %d, enabling.\n"), | 
 | 			bp_num, loc_num); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  loc->disabled_by_cond = false; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |   catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (loc->enabled) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* Warn if a user-enabled location is now becoming disabled-by-cond. | 
 | 	     BP_NUM is 0 if the breakpoint is being defined for the first | 
 | 	     time using the "break ... if ..." command, and non-zero if | 
 | 	     already defined.  */ | 
 | 	  if (bp_num != 0) | 
 | 	    warning (_("failed to validate condition at location %d.%d, " | 
 | 		       "disabling:\n  %s"), bp_num, loc_num, e.what ()); | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    warning (_("failed to validate condition at location %d, " | 
 | 		       "disabling:\n  %s"), loc_num, e.what ()); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       loc->disabled_by_cond = true; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (has_junk) | 
 |     error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), cond_string); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | notify_breakpoint_modified (breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   interps_notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
 |   gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp, | 
 | 			  int from_tty, bool force) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (*exp == 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       b->cond_string.reset (); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (is_watchpoint (b)) | 
 | 	gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (b)->cond_exp.reset (); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  int loc_num = 1; | 
 | 	  for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      loc.cond.reset (); | 
 | 	      if (loc.disabled_by_cond && loc.enabled) | 
 | 		gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is now valid at " | 
 | 			      "location %d, enabling.\n"), | 
 | 			    b->number, loc_num); | 
 | 	      loc.disabled_by_cond = false; | 
 | 	      loc_num++; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      /* No need to free the condition agent expression | 
 | 		 bytecode (if we have one).  We will handle this | 
 | 		 when we go through update_global_location_list.  */ | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (from_tty) | 
 | 	gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (is_watchpoint (b)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  innermost_block_tracker tracker; | 
 | 	  const char *arg = exp; | 
 | 	  expression_up new_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker); | 
 | 	  if (*arg != 0) | 
 | 	    error (_("Junk at end of expression")); | 
 | 	  watchpoint *w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (b); | 
 | 	  w->cond_exp = std::move (new_exp); | 
 | 	  w->cond_exp_valid_block = tracker.block (); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* Parse and set condition expressions.  We make two passes. | 
 | 	     In the first, we parse the condition string to see if it | 
 | 	     is valid in at least one location.  If so, the condition | 
 | 	     would be accepted.  So we go ahead and set the locations' | 
 | 	     conditions.  In case no valid case is found, we throw | 
 | 	     the error and the condition string will be rejected. | 
 | 	     This two-pass approach is taken to avoid setting the | 
 | 	     state of locations in case of a reject.  */ | 
 | 	  for (const bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      try | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  const char *arg = exp; | 
 | 		  parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc.address, | 
 | 			       block_for_pc (loc.address), 0); | 
 | 		  if (*arg != 0) | 
 | 		    error (_("Junk at end of expression")); | 
 | 		  break; | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	      catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  /* Condition string is invalid.  If this happens to | 
 | 		     be the last loc, abandon (if not forced) or continue | 
 | 		     (if forced).  */ | 
 | 		  if (&loc == &b->last_loc () && !force) | 
 | 		    throw; | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	    } | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* If we reach here, the condition is valid at some locations.  */ | 
 | 	  int loc_num = 1; | 
 | 	  for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      set_breakpoint_location_condition (exp, &loc, b->number, loc_num); | 
 | 	      loc_num++; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* We know that the new condition parsed successfully.  The | 
 | 	 condition string of the breakpoint can be safely updated.  */ | 
 |       b->cond_string = make_unique_xstrdup (exp); | 
 |       b->condition_not_parsed = 0; | 
 |     } | 
 |   mark_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
 |  | 
 |   notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | set_breakpoint_condition (int bpnum, const char *exp, int from_tty, | 
 | 			  bool force) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (b.number == bpnum) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	/* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an | 
 | 	   extension language.  This method and conditions entered into GDB | 
 | 	   from the CLI are mutually exclusive.  */ | 
 | 	const struct extension_language_defn *extlang | 
 | 	  = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (&b, EXT_LANG_NONE); | 
 |  | 
 | 	if (extlang != NULL) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    error (_("Only one stop condition allowed.  There is currently" | 
 | 		     " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."), | 
 | 		   ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang)); | 
 | 	  } | 
 | 	set_breakpoint_condition (&b, exp, from_tty, force); | 
 |  | 
 | 	if (is_breakpoint (&b)) | 
 | 	  update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
 |  | 
 | 	return; | 
 |       } | 
 |  | 
 |   error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bpnum); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* The options for the "condition" command.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | struct condition_command_opts | 
 | { | 
 |   /* For "-force".  */ | 
 |   bool force_condition = false; | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | static const gdb::option::option_def condition_command_option_defs[] = { | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb::option::flag_option_def<condition_command_opts> { | 
 |     "force", | 
 |     [] (condition_command_opts *opts) { return &opts->force_condition; }, | 
 |     N_("Set the condition even if it is invalid for all current locations."), | 
 |   }, | 
 |  | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Create an option_def_group for the "condition" options, with | 
 |    CC_OPTS as context.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static inline gdb::option::option_def_group | 
 | make_condition_command_options_def_group (condition_command_opts *cc_opts) | 
 | { | 
 |   return {{condition_command_option_defs}, cc_opts}; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Completion for the "condition" command.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd, | 
 | 		     completion_tracker &tracker, | 
 | 		     const char *text, const char * /*word*/) | 
 | { | 
 |   bool has_no_arguments = (*text == '\0'); | 
 |   condition_command_opts cc_opts; | 
 |   const auto group = make_condition_command_options_def_group (&cc_opts); | 
 |   if (gdb::option::complete_options | 
 |       (tracker, &text, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_ERROR, group)) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   text = skip_spaces (text); | 
 |   const char *space = skip_to_space (text); | 
 |   if (*space == '\0') | 
 |     { | 
 |       int len; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (text[0] == '$') | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  tracker.advance_custom_word_point_by (1); | 
 | 	  /* We don't support completion of history indices.  */ | 
 | 	  if (!c_isdigit (text[1])) | 
 | 	    complete_internalvar (tracker, &text[1]); | 
 | 	  return; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Suggest the "-force" flag if no arguments are given.  If | 
 | 	 arguments were passed, they either already include the flag, | 
 | 	 or we are beyond the point of suggesting it because it's | 
 | 	 positionally the first argument.  */ | 
 |       if (has_no_arguments) | 
 | 	gdb::option::complete_on_all_options (tracker, group); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* We're completing the breakpoint number.  */ | 
 |       len = strlen (text); | 
 |  | 
 |       for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  char number[50]; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b.number); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0) | 
 | 	    tracker.add_completion (make_unique_xstrdup (number)); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       return; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* We're completing the expression part.  Skip the breakpoint num.  */ | 
 |   const char *exp_start = skip_spaces (space); | 
 |   tracker.advance_custom_word_point_by (exp_start - text); | 
 |   text = exp_start; | 
 |   const char *word = advance_to_expression_complete_word_point (tracker, text); | 
 |   expression_completer (cmd, tracker, text, word); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | condition_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   const char *p; | 
 |   int bnum; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (arg == 0) | 
 |     error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number")); | 
 |  | 
 |   p = arg; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Check if the "-force" flag was passed.  */ | 
 |   condition_command_opts cc_opts; | 
 |   const auto group = make_condition_command_options_def_group (&cc_opts); | 
 |   gdb::option::process_options | 
 |     (&p, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_ERROR, group); | 
 |  | 
 |   bnum = get_number (&p); | 
 |   if (bnum == 0) | 
 |     error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg); | 
 |  | 
 |   set_breakpoint_condition (bnum, p, from_tty, cc_opts.force_condition); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable | 
 |    only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints. | 
 |    Throw if any such commands is found.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct command_line *c; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (c = commands; c; c = c->next) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control) | 
 | 	error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can " | 
 | 		 "only be used for tracepoints")); | 
 |  | 
 |       check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_0.get ()); | 
 |       check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_1.get ()); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment | 
 | 	 lines and also empty lines.  So, we only need to check for | 
 | 	 command directly.  */ | 
 |       if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line) | 
 | 	error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints")); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line) | 
 | 	error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints")); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | struct longjmp_breakpoint : public momentary_breakpoint | 
 | { | 
 |   using momentary_breakpoint::momentary_breakpoint; | 
 |  | 
 |   ~longjmp_breakpoint () override; | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | is_tracepoint_type (bptype type) | 
 | { | 
 |   return (type == bp_tracepoint | 
 | 	  || type == bp_fast_tracepoint | 
 | 	  || type == bp_static_tracepoint | 
 | 	  || type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bool | 
 | is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   return is_tracepoint_type (b->type); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given | 
 |    TYPE.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | template<typename... Arg> | 
 | static std::unique_ptr<code_breakpoint> | 
 | new_breakpoint_from_type (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, bptype type, | 
 | 			  Arg&&... args) | 
 | { | 
 |   code_breakpoint *b; | 
 |  | 
 |   switch (type) | 
 |     { | 
 |     case bp_breakpoint: | 
 |     case bp_hardware_breakpoint: | 
 |       b = new ordinary_breakpoint (gdbarch, type, | 
 | 				   std::forward<Arg> (args)...); | 
 |       break; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_fast_tracepoint: | 
 |     case bp_static_tracepoint: | 
 |     case bp_tracepoint: | 
 |       b = new tracepoint (gdbarch, type, | 
 | 			  std::forward<Arg> (args)...); | 
 |       break; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_static_marker_tracepoint: | 
 |       b = new static_marker_tracepoint (gdbarch, type, | 
 | 					std::forward<Arg> (args)...); | 
 |       break; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_dprintf: | 
 |       b = new dprintf_breakpoint (gdbarch, type, | 
 | 				  std::forward<Arg> (args)...); | 
 |       break; | 
 |  | 
 |     default: | 
 |       gdb_assert_not_reached ("invalid type"); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return std::unique_ptr<code_breakpoint> (b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a | 
 |    breakpoint.  This function will throw an exception if a problem is | 
 |    found.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, | 
 | 				  struct command_line *commands) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (is_tracepoint (b)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       tracepoint *t = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (b); | 
 |       struct command_line *c; | 
 |       struct command_line *while_stepping = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Reset the while-stepping step count.  The previous commands | 
 | 	 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new | 
 | 	 ones might not.  */ | 
 |       t->step_count = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is | 
 | 	 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one | 
 | 	 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body | 
 | 	 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping. | 
 | 	 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the | 
 | 	 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually | 
 | 	 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's | 
 | 	 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the | 
 | 	 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the | 
 | 	 tracepoint's context.  */ | 
 |       for (c = commands; c; c = c->next) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint) | 
 | 		error (_("The 'while-stepping' command " | 
 | 			 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint")); | 
 | 	      else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint | 
 | 		       || b->type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint) | 
 | 		error (_("The 'while-stepping' command " | 
 | 			 "cannot be used for static tracepoint")); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      if (while_stepping) | 
 | 		error (_("The 'while-stepping' command " | 
 | 			 "can be used only once")); | 
 | 	      else | 
 | 		while_stepping = c; | 
 | 	    } | 
 |  | 
 | 	  validate_actionline (c->line, t); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       if (while_stepping) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  struct command_line *c2; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_list_1 == nullptr); | 
 | 	  c2 = while_stepping->body_list_0.get (); | 
 | 	  for (; c2; c2 = c2->next) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control) | 
 | 		error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested")); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR.  The | 
 |    caller is responsible for releasing the vector.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | std::vector<breakpoint *> | 
 | static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr) | 
 | { | 
 |   std::vector<breakpoint *> found; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (b.type == bp_static_tracepoint | 
 | 	|| b.type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	for (bp_location &loc : b.locations ()) | 
 | 	  if (loc.address == addr) | 
 | 	    found.push_back (&b); | 
 |       } | 
 |  | 
 |   return found; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS.  If breakpoint is tracepoint, | 
 |    validate that only allowed commands are included.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,  | 
 | 			 counted_command_line &&commands) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* If the commands have not changed then there's no need to update | 
 |      anything, and no need to emit a breakpoint modified event.  */ | 
 |   if (commands_equal (b->commands.get (), commands.get ())) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands.get ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   b->commands = std::move (commands); | 
 |   notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint.  Note that this | 
 |    is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's | 
 |    commands.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent) | 
 | { | 
 |   int old_silent = b->silent; | 
 |  | 
 |   b->silent = silent; | 
 |   if (old_silent != silent) | 
 |     notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* THREAD should be -1, meaning no thread restriction, or it should be a | 
 |      valid global thread-id, which are greater than zero.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (thread == -1 || thread > 0); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* It is not valid to set a thread restriction for a breakpoint that | 
 |      already has task or inferior restriction.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (thread == -1 || (b->task == -1 && b->inferior == -1)); | 
 |  | 
 |   int old_thread = b->thread; | 
 |   b->thread = thread; | 
 |   if (old_thread != thread) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* If THREAD is in a different program_space than OLD_THREAD, or the | 
 | 	 breakpoint has switched to or from being thread-specific, then we | 
 | 	 need to re-set the locations of this breakpoint.  First, figure | 
 | 	 out the program_space for the old and new threads, use a value of | 
 | 	 nullptr to indicate the breakpoint is in all program spaces.  */ | 
 |       program_space *old_pspace = nullptr; | 
 |       if (old_thread != -1) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (old_thread); | 
 | 	  gdb_assert (thr != nullptr); | 
 | 	  old_pspace = thr->inf->pspace; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       program_space *new_pspace = nullptr; | 
 |       if (thread != -1) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (thread); | 
 | 	  gdb_assert (thr != nullptr); | 
 | 	  new_pspace = thr->inf->pspace; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* If the program space has changed for this breakpoint, then | 
 | 	 re-evaluate it's locations.  */ | 
 |       if (old_pspace != new_pspace) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* The breakpoint is now associated with a completely different | 
 | 	     program space.  Discard all of the current locations and then | 
 | 	     re-set the breakpoint in the new program space, this will | 
 | 	     create the new locations.  */ | 
 | 	  b->clear_locations (); | 
 | 	  breakpoint_re_set_one (b, new_pspace); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* If the program space didn't change, or the breakpoint didn't | 
 | 	 acquire any new locations after the clear_locations call, then we | 
 | 	 need to notify of the breakpoint modification now.  */ | 
 |       if (old_pspace == new_pspace || !b->has_locations ()) | 
 | 	notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint_set_inferior (struct breakpoint *b, int inferior) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* INFERIOR should be -1, meaning no inferior restriction, or it should | 
 |      be a valid inferior number, which are greater than zero.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (inferior == -1 || inferior > 0); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* It is not valid to set an inferior restriction for a breakpoint that | 
 |      already has a task or thread restriction.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (inferior == -1 || (b->task == -1 && b->thread == -1)); | 
 |  | 
 |   int old_inferior = b->inferior; | 
 |   b->inferior = inferior; | 
 |   if (old_inferior != inferior) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* If INFERIOR is in a different program_space than OLD_INFERIOR, or | 
 | 	 the breakpoint has switch to or from inferior-specific, then we | 
 | 	 need to re-set the locations of this breakpoint.  First, figure | 
 | 	 out the program_space for the old and new inferiors, use a value | 
 | 	 of nullptr to indicate the breakpoint is in all program | 
 | 	 spaces.  */ | 
 |       program_space *old_pspace = nullptr; | 
 |       if (old_inferior != -1) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_id (old_inferior); | 
 | 	  gdb_assert (inf != nullptr); | 
 | 	  old_pspace = inf->pspace; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       program_space *new_pspace = nullptr; | 
 |       if (inferior != -1) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_id (inferior); | 
 | 	  gdb_assert (inf != nullptr); | 
 | 	  new_pspace = inf->pspace; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (old_pspace != new_pspace) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* The breakpoint is now associated with a completely different | 
 | 	     program space.  Discard all of the current locations and then | 
 | 	     re-set the breakpoint in the new program space, this will | 
 | 	     create the new locations.  */ | 
 | 	  b->clear_locations (); | 
 | 	  breakpoint_re_set_one (b, new_pspace); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* If the program space didn't change, or the breakpoint didn't | 
 | 	 acquire any new locations after the clear_locations call, then we | 
 | 	 need to notify of the breakpoint modification now.  */ | 
 |       if (old_pspace == new_pspace || !b->has_locations ()) | 
 | 	notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* TASK should be -1, meaning no task restriction, or it should be a | 
 |      valid task-id, which are greater than zero.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (task == -1 || task > 0); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* It is not valid to set a task restriction for a breakpoint that | 
 |      already has a thread or inferior restriction.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (task == -1 || (b->thread == -1 && b->inferior == -1)); | 
 |  | 
 |   int old_task = b->task; | 
 |   b->task = task; | 
 |   if (old_task != task) | 
 |     notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty, | 
 | 		    struct command_line *control) | 
 | { | 
 |   counted_command_line cmd; | 
 |   /* cmd_read will be true once we have read cmd.  Note that cmd might still be | 
 |      NULL after the call to read_command_lines if the user provides an empty | 
 |      list of command by just typing "end".  */ | 
 |   bool cmd_read = false; | 
 |  | 
 |   std::string new_arg; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (arg == NULL || !*arg) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Argument not explicitly given.  Synthesize it.  */ | 
 |       if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1) | 
 | 	new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1, | 
 | 				 breakpoint_count); | 
 |       else if (breakpoint_count > 0) | 
 | 	new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Create a copy of ARG.  This is needed because the "commands" | 
 | 	 command may be coming from a script.  In that case, the read | 
 | 	 line buffer is going to be overwritten in the lambda of | 
 | 	 'map_breakpoint_numbers' below when reading the next line | 
 | 	 before we are are done parsing the breakpoint numbers.  */ | 
 |       new_arg = arg; | 
 |     } | 
 |   arg = new_arg.c_str (); | 
 |  | 
 |   map_breakpoint_numbers | 
 |     (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b) | 
 |      { | 
 |        if (!cmd_read) | 
 | 	 { | 
 | 	   gdb_assert (cmd == NULL); | 
 | 	   if (control != NULL) | 
 | 	     cmd = control->body_list_0; | 
 | 	   else | 
 | 	     { | 
 | 	       std::string str | 
 | 		 = string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) " | 
 | 				    "%s, one per line."), | 
 | 				  arg); | 
 |  | 
 | 	       auto do_validate = [=] (const char *line) | 
 | 				  { | 
 | 				    tracepoint *t | 
 | 				      = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (b); | 
 | 				    validate_actionline (line, t); | 
 | 				  }; | 
 | 	       gdb::function_view<void (const char *)> validator; | 
 | 	       if (is_tracepoint (b)) | 
 | 		 validator = do_validate; | 
 |  | 
 | 	       cmd = read_command_lines (str.c_str (), from_tty, 1, validator); | 
 | 	     } | 
 | 	   cmd_read = true; | 
 | 	 } | 
 |  | 
 |        /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to | 
 | 	  do anything.  */ | 
 |        if (b->commands != cmd) | 
 | 	 { | 
 | 	   validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, cmd.get ()); | 
 | 	   b->commands = cmd; | 
 | 	   notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
 | 	 } | 
 |      }); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | commands_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from | 
 |    input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure. | 
 |  | 
 |    This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands | 
 |    that are part of if and while bodies.  */ | 
 | enum command_control_type | 
 | commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd) | 
 | { | 
 |   commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd); | 
 |   return simple_control; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return true if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |   if (!bl->inserted) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |   if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0) | 
 |     /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory.  */ | 
 |     return false; | 
 |   return true; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address | 
 |    MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed | 
 |    contents. | 
 |  | 
 |    If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of | 
 |    the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer.  Otherwise, a | 
 |    failed assertion internal error will be raised.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf, | 
 | 			    const gdb_byte *writebuf_org, | 
 | 			    ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len, | 
 | 			    struct bp_target_info *target_info, | 
 | 			    struct gdbarch *gdbarch) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements.  */ | 
 |   CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0; | 
 |   int bp_size = 0; | 
 |   int bptoffset = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0, | 
 | 				 current_program_space->aspace.get (), 0)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space.  */ | 
 |       return; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that | 
 |      we need to copy.  */ | 
 |   bp_addr = target_info->placed_address; | 
 |   bp_size = target_info->shadow_len; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are | 
 | 	 reading.  */ | 
 |       return; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are | 
 | 	 reading.  */ | 
 |       return; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Offset within shadow_contents.  */ | 
 |   if (bp_addr < memaddr) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint.  */ | 
 |       bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr; | 
 |       bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr; | 
 |       bp_addr = memaddr; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint.  */ | 
 |       bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (readbuf != NULL) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the | 
 | 	 shadow_contents buffer.  */ | 
 |       gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len | 
 | 		  || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents | 
 | 				 + target_info->shadow_len)); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's | 
 | 	 shadow.  */ | 
 |       memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr, | 
 | 	      target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       const unsigned char *bp; | 
 |       CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address; | 
 |       int placed_size; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory.  */ | 
 |       memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, | 
 | 	      writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this | 
 | 	 address.  */ | 
 |       bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted | 
 | 	 breakpoint's INSN.  */ | 
 |       memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR, | 
 |    by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents. | 
 |  | 
 |    If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of | 
 |    the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers.  Otherwise, | 
 |    a failed assertion internal error will be raised. | 
 |  | 
 |    The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is: | 
 |      bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max | 
 |      up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max | 
 |    The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is: | 
 |      memaddr ... memaddr + len | 
 |    Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are | 
 |      memaddr + len <= (bl->address | 
 | 		       - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max) | 
 |    and: | 
 |      bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf, | 
 | 			const gdb_byte *writebuf_org, | 
 | 			ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary | 
 |      search.  */ | 
 |   unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF | 
 |      content.  It is safe to report lower value but a failure to | 
 |      report higher one.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   bc_l = 0; | 
 |   bc_r = bp_locations.size (); | 
 |   while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct bp_location *bl; | 
 |  | 
 |       bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2; | 
 |       bl = bp_locations[bc]; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added | 
 | 	 constant.  Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure | 
 | 	 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR | 
 | 	 to MEMADDR + LEN range). | 
 |  | 
 | 	 Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety | 
 | 	 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow | 
 | 	 range tail still reaching MEMADDR.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |       if ((bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max | 
 | 	   >= bl->address) | 
 | 	  && (bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max | 
 | 	      <= memaddr)) | 
 | 	bc_l = bc; | 
 |       else | 
 | 	bc_r = bc; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the | 
 |      first location that's at BC_L's address.  E.g., if there are | 
 |      multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing | 
 |      at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted" | 
 |      location.  Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and | 
 |      B: | 
 |  | 
 |       L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ... | 
 |  | 
 |      BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master" | 
 |      location could be L1.  Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set | 
 |      on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1 | 
 |      and L2.  */ | 
 |   while (bc_l > 0 | 
 | 	 && bp_locations[bc_l]->address == bp_locations[bc_l - 1]->address) | 
 |     bc_l--; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_locations.size (); bc++) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct bp_location *bl = bp_locations[bc]; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL.  */ | 
 |       if (bl->owner->type == bp_none) | 
 | 	warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"), | 
 | 		 bl->owner->number); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF | 
 | 	 content.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |       if (bl->address >= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max | 
 | 	  && (memaddr + len | 
 | 	      <= (bl->address | 
 | 		  - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max))) | 
 | 	break; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org, | 
 | 				  memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bool | 
 | is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
 | { | 
 |   return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint | 
 | 	  || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint | 
 | 	  || bpt->type == bp_dprintf); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
 | { | 
 |   return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint | 
 | 	  || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint | 
 | 	  || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bool | 
 | is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
 | { | 
 |   return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt) | 
 | 	  || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe | 
 |    to evaluate or update watchpoint B.  Watchpoints on local | 
 |    expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that | 
 |    was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs | 
 |    to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context. | 
 |    Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread, | 
 |    and in any state.  It is presently left to the target allowing | 
 |    memory accesses when threads are running.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   return (b->pspace == current_program_space | 
 | 	  && (b->watchpoint_thread == null_ptid | 
 | 	      || (inferior_ptid == b->watchpoint_thread | 
 | 		  && !inferior_thread ()->executing ()))); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible | 
 |    associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (w->related_breakpoint != w) | 
 |     { | 
 |       gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope); | 
 |       gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == w); | 
 |       w->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; | 
 |       w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w->related_breakpoint; | 
 |       w->related_breakpoint = w; | 
 |     } | 
 |   w->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; | 
 |   disable_breakpoint (w); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in | 
 |    watchpoint W.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static struct value * | 
 | extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct value *bit_val; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (val == NULL) | 
 |     return NULL; | 
 |  | 
 |   bit_val = value::allocate (val->type ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   val->unpack_bitfield (bit_val, | 
 | 			w->val_bitpos, | 
 | 			w->val_bitsize, | 
 | 			val->contents_for_printing ().data (), | 
 | 			val->offset ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   return bit_val; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B.  This is required | 
 |    because bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report | 
 |    stops.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | add_dummy_location (struct breakpoint *b, | 
 | 		    struct program_space *pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_assert (!b->has_locations ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   bp_location *loc = new bp_location (b, bp_loc_other); | 
 |   loc->pspace = pspace; | 
 |   b->add_location (*loc); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: | 
 |    - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is true | 
 |    - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val | 
 |    - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result | 
 |      in b->loc->cond. | 
 |    - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc. | 
 |  | 
 |    If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do | 
 |    nothing.  If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete | 
 |    it. | 
 |  | 
 |    Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are | 
 |    removed + inserted on each stop here.  Normal breakpoints must | 
 |    never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread | 
 |    when debugging in non-stop mode.  On the other hand, hardware | 
 |    watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific | 
 |    to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug | 
 |    registers.  Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to | 
 |    be able to modify its hardware watchpoints. | 
 |  | 
 |    Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being | 
 |    presented to the user.  It cannot be done sooner, because it would | 
 |    reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user.  And | 
 |    it must not be done later because it could display the same single | 
 |    watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops.  Note that the latter is | 
 |    relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint | 
 |    and bp_access_watchpoint.  False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is | 
 |    not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has | 
 |    not changed. | 
 |  | 
 |    The following constraints influence the location where we can reset | 
 |    hardware watchpoints: | 
 |  | 
 |    * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are | 
 |      called several times when GDB stops. | 
 |  | 
 |    [linux]  | 
 |    * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time, | 
 |      causing GDB to stop.  GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint | 
 |      hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits | 
 |      are presented later, one after the other, each time the user | 
 |      requests the execution to be resumed.  Execution is not resumed | 
 |      for the threads still having pending hit event stored in | 
 |      LWP_INFO->STATUS.  While the watchpoint is already removed from | 
 |      the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being | 
 |      reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address | 
 |      until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets | 
 |      presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset. | 
 |  | 
 |    Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the | 
 |    watchpoint removal from inferior.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, bool reparse) | 
 | { | 
 |   bool within_current_scope; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the | 
 |      watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread | 
 |      that was used to create the watchpoint.  */ | 
 |   if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b)) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   std::optional<scoped_restore_selected_frame> restore_frame; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope.  */ | 
 |   if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL) | 
 |     within_current_scope = true; | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       frame_info_ptr fi = get_current_frame (); | 
 |       struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi); | 
 |       CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed | 
 | 	 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work | 
 | 	 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this | 
 | 	 point.  See similar comments in watchpoint_check.  */ | 
 |       if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc)) | 
 | 	return; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after | 
 | 	 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame.  */ | 
 |       /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression | 
 | 	 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the | 
 | 	 selected frame.  */ | 
 |       restore_frame.emplace (); | 
 |  | 
 |       fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame); | 
 |       within_current_scope = (fi != NULL); | 
 |       if (within_current_scope) | 
 | 	select_frame (fi); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* We don't free locations.  They are stored in the bp_location array | 
 |      and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and | 
 |      remove breakpoints if needed.  */ | 
 |   b->clear_locations (); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (within_current_scope && reparse) | 
 |     { | 
 |       const char *s; | 
 |  | 
 |       b->exp.reset (); | 
 |       s = (b->exp_string_reparse | 
 | 	   ? b->exp_string_reparse.get () | 
 | 	   : b->exp_string.get ()); | 
 |       b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0); | 
 |       /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is | 
 | 	 no longer relevant.  We don't want to report a watchpoint hit | 
 | 	 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually | 
 | 	 be completely different objects.  */ | 
 |       b->val = NULL; | 
 |       b->val_valid = false; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition | 
 | 	 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the | 
 | 	 locations (re)created below.  */ | 
 |       if (b->cond_string != NULL) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  b->cond_exp.reset (); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  s = b->cond_string.get (); | 
 | 	  b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because | 
 |      it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library, | 
 |      don't try to insert watchpoint.  We don't automatically delete | 
 |      such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression | 
 |      is different from out-of-scope watchpoint.  */ | 
 |   if (!target_has_execution ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Without execution, memory can't change.  No use to try and | 
 | 	 set watchpoint locations.  The watchpoint will be reset when | 
 | 	 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set.  */ | 
 |       if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (b->works_in_software_mode ()) | 
 | 	    b->type = bp_watchpoint; | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when " | 
 | 		     "hardware watchpoints are disabled.")); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |   else if (within_current_scope && b->exp) | 
 |     { | 
 |       std::vector<value_ref_ptr> val_chain; | 
 |       struct value *v, *result; | 
 |       struct program_space *wp_pspace; | 
 |  | 
 |       fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), b->exp->op.get (), &v, &result, | 
 | 			  &val_chain, false); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set.  The meaning of | 
 | 	 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update | 
 | 	 it only if we reported that last value to user.  As it | 
 | 	 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. | 
 | 	 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked | 
 | 	 watchpoints.  */ | 
 |       if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (b)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (b->val_bitsize != 0) | 
 | 	    v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v); | 
 | 	  b->val = release_value (v); | 
 | 	  b->val_valid = true; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (b->exp_valid_block == nullptr) | 
 | 	wp_pspace = current_program_space; | 
 |       else | 
 | 	wp_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL)); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Look at each value on the value chain.  */ | 
 |       gdb_assert (!val_chain.empty ()); | 
 |       for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : val_chain) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  v = iter.get (); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed | 
 | 	     its contents to evaluate the expression, then we | 
 | 	     must watch it.  If the first value returned is | 
 | 	     still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it; | 
 | 	     watch it anyway in case it becomes readable.  */ | 
 | 	  if (v->lval () == lval_memory | 
 | 	      && (v == val_chain[0] || ! v->lazy ())) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      struct type *vtype = check_typedef (v->type ()); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked | 
 | 		 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to | 
 | 		 appear in the middle of some value chain.  */ | 
 | 	      if (v == result | 
 | 		  || (vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT | 
 | 		      && vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  CORE_ADDR addr; | 
 | 		  enum target_hw_bp_type type; | 
 | 		  int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0; | 
 |  | 
 | 		  if (v->bitsize () != 0) | 
 | 		    { | 
 | 		      /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield | 
 | 			 sub-expression.  */ | 
 | 		      bitpos = v->bitpos (); | 
 | 		      bitsize = v->bitsize (); | 
 | 		    } | 
 | 		  else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0) | 
 | 		    { | 
 | 		     /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield | 
 | 			lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields | 
 | 			VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE.  */ | 
 | 		      bitpos = b->val_bitpos; | 
 | 		      bitsize = b->val_bitsize; | 
 | 		    } | 
 |  | 
 | 		  addr = v->address (); | 
 | 		  if (bitsize != 0) | 
 | 		    { | 
 | 		      /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield.  */ | 
 | 		      addr += bitpos / 8; | 
 | 		    } | 
 |  | 
 | 		  type = hw_write; | 
 | 		  if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint) | 
 | 		    type = hw_read; | 
 | 		  else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint) | 
 | 		    type = hw_access; | 
 |  | 
 | 		  bp_location *loc = b->allocate_location (); | 
 | 		  loc->gdbarch = v->type ()->arch (); | 
 | 		  loc->pspace = wp_pspace; | 
 | 		  loc->address | 
 | 		    = gdbarch_remove_non_address_bits_watchpoint (loc->gdbarch, | 
 | 								  addr); | 
 | 		  b->add_location (*loc); | 
 |  | 
 | 		  if (bitsize != 0) | 
 | 		    { | 
 | 		      /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield.  */ | 
 | 		      loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8; | 
 | 		    } | 
 | 		  else | 
 | 		    loc->length = v->type ()->length (); | 
 |  | 
 | 		  loc->watchpoint_type = type; | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Helper function to bundle possibly emitting a warning along with | 
 | 	 changing the type of B to bp_watchpoint.  */ | 
 |       auto change_type_to_bp_watchpoint = [] (breakpoint *bp) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	/* Only warn for breakpoints that have been assigned a +ve number, | 
 | 	   anything else is either an internal watchpoint (which we don't | 
 | 	   currently create) or has not yet been finalized, in which case | 
 | 	   this change of type will be occurring before the user is told | 
 | 	   the type of this watchpoint.  */ | 
 | 	if (bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bp->number > 0) | 
 | 	  warning (_("watchpoint %d downgraded to software watchpoint"), | 
 | 		   bp->number); | 
 | 	bp->type = bp_watchpoint; | 
 |       }; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or | 
 | 	 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support and | 
 | 	 free hardware slots.  Recheck the number of free hardware slots | 
 | 	 as the value chain may have changed.  */ | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  int reg_cnt; | 
 | 	  enum bp_loc_type loc_type; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (reg_cnt) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used; | 
 | 	      enum bptype type; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be | 
 | 		 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it.  */ | 
 | 	      b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      /* We need to determine how many resources are already | 
 | 		 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one | 
 | 		 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit | 
 | 		 this watchpoint in as well.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	      /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it | 
 | 		 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of | 
 | 		 hardware watchpoint type.  */ | 
 | 	      type = b->type; | 
 | 	      if (type == bp_watchpoint) | 
 | 		type = bp_hardware_watchpoint; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on | 
 | 		 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list | 
 | 		 if we're trying to create it for the first time, | 
 | 		 through watch_command), so always account for it | 
 | 		 manually.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	      /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B.  */ | 
 | 	      i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b, type, &other_type_used); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      /* Add in the resources needed for B.  */ | 
 | 	      i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      target_resources_ok | 
 | 		= target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used); | 
 | 	      if (target_resources_ok <= 0) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  bool sw_mode = b->works_in_software_mode (); | 
 |  | 
 | 		  if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode) | 
 | 		    error (_("Target does not support this type of " | 
 | 			     "hardware watchpoint.")); | 
 | 		  else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode) | 
 | 		    error (_("There are not enough available hardware " | 
 | 			     "resources for this watchpoint.")); | 
 |  | 
 | 		  /* Downgrade to software watchpoint.  */ | 
 | 		  change_type_to_bp_watchpoint (b); | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	      else | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just | 
 | 		     found we have enough resources to turn it to a | 
 | 		     hardware watchpoint.  Otherwise, this is a | 
 | 		     nop.  */ | 
 | 		  b->type = type; | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else if (!b->works_in_software_mode ()) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints) | 
 | 		error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when " | 
 | 			 "hardware watchpoints are disabled.")); | 
 | 	      else | 
 | 		error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with " | 
 | 			 "read/access watchpoint.")); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    change_type_to_bp_watchpoint (b); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_software_watchpoint | 
 | 		      : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  for (bp_location &bl : b->locations ()) | 
 | 	    bl.loc_type = loc_type; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the | 
 | 	 above left it without any location set up.  But, | 
 | 	 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report | 
 | 	 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one.  */ | 
 |       if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && !b->has_locations ()) | 
 | 	add_dummy_location (b, wp_pspace); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else if (!within_current_scope) | 
 |     { | 
 |       gdb_printf (_("\ | 
 | Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\ | 
 | in which its expression is valid.\n"), | 
 | 		  b->number); | 
 |       watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Returns true iff breakpoint location should be | 
 |    inserted in the inferior.  We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner | 
 |    (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's | 
 |    breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location, | 
 |    tracepoint's insert_location will not be called.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!bl->enabled || bl->disabled_by_cond | 
 |       || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a | 
 |      vfork, and have detached from the child.  The child is running | 
 |      free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the | 
 |      OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports | 
 |      that the vfork is done).  Until the child is done with the shared | 
 |      memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise | 
 |      the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints.  Since | 
 |      the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint.  */ | 
 |   if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its | 
 |      location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint, | 
 |      and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past | 
 |      a breakpoint.  */ | 
 |   if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
 |        || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 |       && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace.get (), | 
 | 				       bl->address) | 
 |       /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location | 
 | 	 we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself. | 
 | 	 However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may | 
 | 	 break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the | 
 | 	 instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags. | 
 | 	 We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction | 
 | 	 or switch to displaced stepping.  */ | 
 |       && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step | 
 | 	   && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread))) | 
 |     { | 
 |       infrun_debug_printf ("skipping breakpoint: stepping past insn at: %s", | 
 | 			   paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address)); | 
 |       return false; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the | 
 |      instruction that triggered one.  */ | 
 |   if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint) | 
 |       && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       infrun_debug_printf ("stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. " | 
 | 			   "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d", | 
 | 			   paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address), bl->length); | 
 |       return false; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return true; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming | 
 |    that the location is not duplicated.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   scoped_restore restore_bl_duplicate | 
 |     = make_scoped_restore (&bl->duplicate, 0); | 
 |  | 
 |   return should_be_inserted (bl); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an | 
 |    agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation | 
 |    by the bytecode interpreter.  Return NULL if there was | 
 |    any error during parsing.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static agent_expr_up | 
 | parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (cond == NULL) | 
 |     return NULL; | 
 |  | 
 |   agent_expr_up aexpr; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors | 
 |      that may show up.  */ | 
 |   try | 
 |     { | 
 |       aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid | 
 | 	 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side. | 
 | 	 It's no use iterating through the conditions.  */ | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* We have a valid agent expression.  */ | 
 |   return aexpr; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be | 
 |    passed on to the target.  If we have duplicated locations with different | 
 |    conditions, we will add such conditions to the list.  The idea is that the | 
 |    target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when | 
 |    one of them is true.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   bool null_condition_or_parse_error = false; | 
 |   int modified = bl->needs_update; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert.  */ | 
 |   bl->target_info.conditions.clear (); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* This is only meaningful if the target is | 
 |      evaluating conditions and if the user has | 
 |      opted for condition evaluation on the target's | 
 |      side.  */ | 
 |   if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | 
 |       || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   auto loc_range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (bl->address); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned | 
 |      conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent | 
 |      expression bytecode.  If any of these happen, then it's no use to | 
 |      send conditions to the target since this location will always | 
 |      trigger and generate a response back to GDB.  Note we consider | 
 |      all locations at the same address irrespective of type, i.e., | 
 |      even if the locations aren't considered duplicates (e.g., | 
 |      software breakpoint and hardware breakpoint at the same | 
 |      address).  */ | 
 |   for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (modified) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed.  In that | 
 | 		 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see | 
 | 		 force_breakpoint_reinsertion).  We just | 
 | 		 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again.  */ | 
 | 	      loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address, | 
 | 							loc->cond.get ()); | 
 | 	    } | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something | 
 | 	     went wrong or we have a null condition expression.  */ | 
 | 	  if (!loc->cond_bytecode) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      null_condition_or_parse_error = true; | 
 | 	      break; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions | 
 |      for the location's address on gdb's side.  It is no use keeping bytecodes | 
 |      for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here. | 
 |  | 
 |      This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are | 
 |      being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub.  */ | 
 |   if (null_condition_or_parse_error) | 
 |     { | 
 |       for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is | 
 | 		 located.  */ | 
 | 	      if (!loc->cond_bytecode) | 
 | 		return; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      loc->cond_bytecode.reset (); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation.  Build a | 
 |      condition list for this location's address.  If we have software | 
 |      and hardware locations at the same address, they aren't | 
 |      considered duplicates, but we still merge all the conditions | 
 |      anyway, as it's simpler, and doesn't really make a practical | 
 |      difference.  */ | 
 |   for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) | 
 |     if (loc->cond | 
 | 	&& is_breakpoint (loc->owner) | 
 | 	&& loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num | 
 | 	&& loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled | 
 | 	&& loc->enabled | 
 | 	&& !loc->disabled_by_cond) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	/* Add the condition to the vector.  This will be used later | 
 | 	   to send the conditions to the target.  */ | 
 | 	bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ()); | 
 |       } | 
 |  | 
 |   return; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression | 
 |    bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter. | 
 |    Return NULL if there was any error during parsing.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static agent_expr_up | 
 | parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd) | 
 | { | 
 |   const char *cmdrest; | 
 |   const char *format_start, *format_end; | 
 |   struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch (); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (cmd == NULL) | 
 |     return NULL; | 
 |  | 
 |   cmdrest = cmd; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (*cmdrest == ',') | 
 |     ++cmdrest; | 
 |   cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (*cmdrest++ != '"') | 
 |     error (_("No format string following the location")); | 
 |  | 
 |   format_start = cmdrest; | 
 |  | 
 |   format_pieces fpieces (&cmdrest); | 
 |  | 
 |   format_end = cmdrest; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (*cmdrest++ != '"') | 
 |     error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'.")); | 
 |    | 
 |   cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0')) | 
 |     error (_("Invalid argument syntax")); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (*cmdrest == ',') | 
 |     cmdrest++; | 
 |   cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* For each argument, make an expression.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   std::vector<struct expression *> argvec; | 
 |   while (*cmdrest != '\0') | 
 |     { | 
 |       const char *cmd1; | 
 |  | 
 |       cmd1 = cmdrest; | 
 |       expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), | 
 | 					PARSER_COMMA_TERMINATES); | 
 |       argvec.push_back (expr.release ()); | 
 |       cmdrest = cmd1; | 
 |       if (*cmdrest == ',') | 
 | 	++cmdrest; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   agent_expr_up aexpr; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors | 
 |      that may show up.  */ | 
 |   try | 
 |     { | 
 |       aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0, | 
 | 			  format_start, format_end - format_start, | 
 | 			  argvec.size (), argvec.data ()); | 
 |     } | 
 |   catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid | 
 | 	 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side. | 
 | 	 It's no use iterating through the other commands.  */ | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* We have a valid agent expression, return it.  */ | 
 |   return aexpr; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be | 
 |    passed on to the target.  If we have duplicated locations with | 
 |    different commands, we will add any such to the list.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   bool null_command_or_parse_error = false; | 
 |   int modified = bl->needs_update; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert.  */ | 
 |   bl->target_info.tcommands.clear (); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ()) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints.  */ | 
 |   if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   auto loc_range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (bl->address); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* For now, if we have any location at the same address that isn't a | 
 |      dprintf, don't install the target-side commands, as that would | 
 |      make the breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose | 
 |      control.  */ | 
 |   for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) | 
 |     if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) | 
 | 	&& loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num | 
 | 	&& loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf) | 
 |       return; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned | 
 |      conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression | 
 |      bytecode.  If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions | 
 |      to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a | 
 |      response back to GDB.  */ | 
 |   for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (modified) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Re-parse the commands since something changed.  In that | 
 | 		 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see | 
 | 		 force_breakpoint_reinsertion).  We just | 
 | 		 need to parse the command to bytecodes again.  */ | 
 | 	      loc->cmd_bytecode | 
 | 		= parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address, | 
 | 				      loc->owner->extra_string.get ()); | 
 | 	    } | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something | 
 | 	     went wrong or we have a null command expression.  */ | 
 | 	  if (!loc->cmd_bytecode) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      null_command_or_parse_error = true; | 
 | 	      break; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands, | 
 |      and so clean up.  */ | 
 |   if (null_command_or_parse_error) | 
 |     { | 
 |       for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) | 
 | 	if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) | 
 | 	    && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is | 
 | 	       located.  */ | 
 | 	    if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL) | 
 | 	      return; | 
 |  | 
 | 	    loc->cmd_bytecode.reset (); | 
 | 	  } | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation.  Build a command | 
 |      list for all duplicate locations at this location's address. | 
 |      Note that here we must care for whether the breakpoint location | 
 |      types are considered duplicates, otherwise, say, if we have a | 
 |      software and hardware location at the same address, the target | 
 |      could end up running the commands twice.  For the moment, we only | 
 |      support targets-side commands with dprintf, but it doesn't hurt | 
 |      to be pedantically correct in case that changes.  */ | 
 |   for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) | 
 |     if (breakpoint_locations_match (bl, loc) | 
 | 	&& loc->owner->extra_string | 
 | 	&& is_breakpoint (loc->owner) | 
 | 	&& loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num | 
 | 	&& loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled | 
 | 	&& loc->enabled | 
 | 	&& !loc->disabled_by_cond) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	/* Add the command to the vector.  This will be used later | 
 | 	   to send the commands to the target.  */ | 
 | 	bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ()); | 
 |       } | 
 |  | 
 |   bl->target_info.persist = 0; | 
 |   /* Maybe flag this location as persistent.  */ | 
 |   if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf) | 
 |     bl->target_info.persist = 1; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR.  Get the kind | 
 |    of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint. | 
 |    Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current | 
 |    registers state.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static int | 
 | breakpoint_kind (const struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread); | 
 |       struct regcache *regcache; | 
 |  | 
 |       regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr); | 
 |  | 
 |       return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch, | 
 | 							 regcache, addr); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Rethrow the currently handled exception, if it's a TARGET_CLOSE_ERROR. | 
 |    E is either the currently handled exception, or a copy, or a sliced copy, | 
 |    so we can't rethrow that one, but we can use it to inspect the properties | 
 |    of the currently handled exception.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | rethrow_on_target_close_error (const gdb_exception &e) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (e.reason == 0) | 
 |     return; | 
 |   /* Can't set the breakpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   if (e.error != TARGET_CLOSE_ERROR) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If the target has closed then it will have deleted any breakpoints | 
 |      inserted within the target inferior, as a result any further attempts | 
 |      to interact with the breakpoint objects is not possible.  Just rethrow | 
 |      the error.  Don't use e to rethrow, to prevent object slicing of the | 
 |      exception.  */ | 
 |   throw; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type.  BL is the breakpoint | 
 |    location.  Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and | 
 |    DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems. | 
 |    Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or | 
 |    -1 for failure. | 
 |  | 
 |    NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an | 
 |    object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type.  */ | 
 | static int | 
 | insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 		    struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream, | 
 | 		    int *disabled_breaks, | 
 | 		    int *hw_breakpoint_error, | 
 | 		    int *hw_bp_error_explained_already) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_exception bp_excpt; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update)) | 
 |     return 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   breakpoint_debug_printf ("%s", breakpoint_location_address_str (bl).c_str ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out | 
 |      the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint | 
 |      is still inserted at that location.  This in turn breaks | 
 |      target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when | 
 |      a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location: | 
 |      Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that | 
 |      we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus | 
 |      read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in | 
 |      the breakpoint location's shadow contents.  */ | 
 |   bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address; | 
 |   bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace.get (); | 
 |   bl->target_info.length = bl->length; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions | 
 |      for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not | 
 |      insert those locations.  With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target | 
 |      can decide when to stop and notify GDB.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       build_target_condition_list (bl); | 
 |       build_target_command_list (bl); | 
 |       /* Reset the modification marker.  */ | 
 |       bl->needs_update = 0; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If "set breakpoint auto-hw" is "on" and a software breakpoint was | 
 |      set at a read-only address, then a breakpoint location will have | 
 |      been changed to hardware breakpoint before we get here.  If it is | 
 |      "off" however, error out before actually trying to insert the | 
 |      breakpoint, with a nicer error message.  */ | 
 |   if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
 |       && !automatic_hardware_breakpoints) | 
 |     { | 
 |       mem_region *mr = lookup_mem_region (bl->address); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (mr != nullptr && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, | 
 | 		      _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n" | 
 | 			"Cannot set software breakpoint " | 
 | 			"at read-only address %s\n"), | 
 | 		      bl->owner->number, | 
 | 		      paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address)); | 
 | 	  return 1; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
 |       || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay.  */ | 
 |       if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off | 
 | 	  || bl->section == NULL | 
 | 	  || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section))) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint.  */ | 
 | 	  try | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      int val; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      val = bl->owner->insert_location (bl); | 
 | 	      if (val) | 
 | 		bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR}; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  catch (gdb_exception &e) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      rethrow_on_target_close_error (e); | 
 | 	      bp_excpt = std::move (e); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section. | 
 | 	     Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA?  */ | 
 | 	  if (!overlay_events_enabled) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,  | 
 | 		 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA. | 
 | 		 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint.  */ | 
 | 	      if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 | 		warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"), | 
 | 			 bl->owner->number); | 
 | 	      else | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address, | 
 | 							     bl->section); | 
 | 		  /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA.  */ | 
 | 		  bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info; | 
 | 		  bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr; | 
 |  | 
 | 		  /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint.  */ | 
 | 		  try | 
 | 		    { | 
 | 		      int val; | 
 |  | 
 | 		      bl->overlay_target_info.kind | 
 | 			= breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr); | 
 | 		      bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr; | 
 | 		      val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, | 
 | 						      &bl->overlay_target_info); | 
 | 		      if (val) | 
 | 			bp_excpt | 
 | 			  = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR}; | 
 | 		    } | 
 | 		  catch (gdb_exception &e) | 
 | 		    { | 
 | 		      rethrow_on_target_close_error (e); | 
 | 		      bp_excpt = std::move (e); | 
 | 		    } | 
 |  | 
 | 		  if (bp_excpt.reason != 0) | 
 | 		    gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, | 
 | 				"Overlay breakpoint %d " | 
 | 				"failed: in ROM?\n", | 
 | 				bl->owner->number); | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */ | 
 | 	  if (section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Yes.  This overlay section is mapped into memory.  */ | 
 | 	      try | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  int val; | 
 |  | 
 | 		  val = bl->owner->insert_location (bl); | 
 | 		  if (val) | 
 | 		    bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR}; | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	      catch (gdb_exception_error &e) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  rethrow_on_target_close_error (e); | 
 | 		  bp_excpt = std::move (e); | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* No.  This breakpoint will not be inserted.   | 
 | 		 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'.  */ | 
 | 	      return 0; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (bp_excpt.reason != 0) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* Can't set the breakpoint.  */ | 
 | 	  gdb_assert (bl->owner != nullptr); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a | 
 | 	     breakpoint in a shared library that has already been | 
 | 	     removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload | 
 | 	     event.  Unfortunately, some targets that implement | 
 | 	     breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the | 
 | 	     breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target | 
 | 	     doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic | 
 | 	     errors as memory errors.  */ | 
 | 	  if (bp_excpt.reason == RETURN_ERROR | 
 | 	      && (bp_excpt.error == GENERIC_ERROR | 
 | 		  || bp_excpt.error == MEMORY_ERROR) | 
 | 	      && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
 | 	      && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address) | 
 | 		  || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace, | 
 | 							bl->address))) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      bl->shlib_disabled = 1; | 
 | 	      notify_breakpoint_modified (bl->owner); | 
 | 	      if (!*disabled_breaks) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream,  | 
 | 			      "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",  | 
 | 			      bl->owner->number); | 
 | 		  gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream,  | 
 | 			      "Temporarily disabling shared " | 
 | 			      "library breakpoints:\n"); | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	      *disabled_breaks = 1; | 
 | 	      gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, | 
 | 			  "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number); | 
 | 	      return 0; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  *hw_breakpoint_error = 1; | 
 | 		  *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_excpt.message != NULL; | 
 | 		  gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, | 
 | 			      "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s", | 
 | 			      bl->owner->number, | 
 | 			      bp_excpt.message ? ":" : ".\n"); | 
 | 		  if (bp_excpt.message != NULL) | 
 | 		    gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n", | 
 | 				bp_excpt.what ()); | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	      else | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  if (bp_excpt.message == NULL) | 
 | 		    { | 
 | 		      std::string message | 
 | 			= memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO, | 
 | 						bl->gdbarch, bl->address); | 
 |  | 
 | 		      gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, | 
 | 				  "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n" | 
 | 				  "%s\n", | 
 | 				  bl->owner->number, message.c_str ()); | 
 | 		    } | 
 | 		  else | 
 | 		    { | 
 | 		      gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, | 
 | 				  "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n", | 
 | 				  bl->owner->number, | 
 | 				  bp_excpt.what ()); | 
 | 		    } | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	      return 1; | 
 |  | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	bl->inserted = 1; | 
 |  | 
 |       return 0; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint | 
 | 	   && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop) | 
 |     { | 
 |       int val; | 
 |  | 
 |       val = bl->owner->insert_location (bl); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not | 
 | 	 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint.  */ | 
 |       if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another | 
 | 	     hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate | 
 | 	     of this one.  */ | 
 | 	  for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 | 	    if (loc != bl | 
 | 		&& loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access | 
 | 		&& watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc)) | 
 | 	      { | 
 | 		bl->duplicate = 1; | 
 | 		bl->inserted = 1; | 
 | 		bl->target_info = loc->target_info; | 
 | 		bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access; | 
 | 		val = 0; | 
 | 		break; | 
 | 	      } | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (val == 1) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access; | 
 | 	      val = bl->owner->insert_location (bl); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      if (val) | 
 | 		/* Back to the original value.  */ | 
 | 		bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       bl->inserted = (val == 0); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint) | 
 |     { | 
 |       int val; | 
 |  | 
 |       val = bl->owner->insert_location (bl); | 
 |       if (val) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (val == 1) | 
 | 	    warning (_("\ | 
 | Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\ | 
 | of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number); | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       bl->inserted = (val == 0); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem | 
 | 	 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint, | 
 | 	 so just return success.  */ | 
 |       return 0; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be | 
 |    deleted.  It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference | 
 |    PSPACE anymore.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space.  */ | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 |     if (b.pspace == pspace) | 
 |       delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations | 
 |      bound to PSPACE as well.  Remove those.  */ | 
 |   for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 |     if (loc->pspace == pspace) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	/* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL.  */ | 
 | 	loc->owner->unadd_location (*loc); | 
 |       } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the | 
 |      removed locations above.  */ | 
 |   update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior. | 
 |    Throws exception on any error. | 
 |    A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted | 
 |    again, so calling this function twice is safe.  */ | 
 | void | 
 | insert_breakpoints (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &bpt : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (is_hardware_watchpoint (&bpt)) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	watchpoint &w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint &> (bpt); | 
 |  | 
 | 	update_watchpoint (&w, false /* don't reparse.  */); | 
 |       } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global | 
 |      location list.  Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and | 
 |      ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode.  Also, | 
 |      update_global_location_list tries to "upgrade" software | 
 |      breakpoints to hardware breakpoints to handle "set breakpoint | 
 |      auto-hw", so we need to call it even if we don't have new | 
 |      locations.  */ | 
 |   update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the | 
 |    target.  It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using | 
 |    always-inserted mode.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   int error_flag = 0; | 
 |   int val = 0; | 
 |   int disabled_breaks = 0; | 
 |   int hw_breakpoint_error = 0; | 
 |   int hw_bp_details_reported = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   string_file tmp_error_stream; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if | 
 |      there was an error.  */ | 
 |   tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n"); | 
 |  | 
 |   scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware | 
 | 	 breakpoints.  */ | 
 |       if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted | 
 | 	 and need updating.  This is to avoid unwanted insertion during | 
 | 	 deletion of breakpoints.  */ | 
 |       if (!bl->inserted || !bl->needs_update) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need | 
 | 	 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to.  In fact, even | 
 | 	 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still | 
 | 	 insert breakpoints.  */ | 
 |       if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (current_inferior ()->arch ()) | 
 | 	  && (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ())) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks, | 
 | 				    &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported); | 
 |       if (val) | 
 | 	error_flag = val; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (error_flag) | 
 |     { | 
 |       target_terminal::ours_for_output (); | 
 |       error (("%s"), tmp_error_stream.c_str ()); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Used when starting or continuing the program.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | insert_breakpoint_locations (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   int error_flag = 0; | 
 |   int val = 0; | 
 |   int disabled_breaks = 0; | 
 |   int hw_breakpoint_error = 0; | 
 |   int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   string_file tmp_error_stream; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if | 
 |      there was an error.  */ | 
 |   tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n"); | 
 |  | 
 |   scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if | 
 | 	 the thread no longer exists.  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location | 
 | 	 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL.  */ | 
 |       if (bl->owner->thread != -1 | 
 | 	  && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Or inferior specific breakpoints if the inferior no longer | 
 | 	 exists.  */ | 
 |       if (bl->owner->inferior != -1 | 
 | 	  && !valid_global_inferior_id (bl->owner->inferior)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need | 
 | 	 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to.  In fact, even | 
 | 	 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still | 
 | 	 insert breakpoints.  */ | 
 |       if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (current_inferior ()->arch ()) | 
 | 	  && (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ())) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks, | 
 | 				    &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already); | 
 |       if (val) | 
 | 	error_flag = val; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove | 
 |      them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use.  */ | 
 |   for (breakpoint &bpt : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       bool some_failed = false; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (&bpt)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!breakpoint_enabled (&bpt)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (bpt.disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       for (bp_location &loc : bpt.locations ()) | 
 | 	if (!loc.inserted && should_be_inserted (&loc)) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    some_failed = true; | 
 | 	    break; | 
 | 	  } | 
 |  | 
 |       if (some_failed) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  for (bp_location &loc : bpt.locations ()) | 
 | 	    if (loc.inserted) | 
 | 	      remove_breakpoint (&loc); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  hw_breakpoint_error = 1; | 
 | 	  tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert " | 
 | 				   "hardware watchpoint %d.\n", | 
 | 				   bpt.number); | 
 | 	  error_flag = -1; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (error_flag) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a | 
 | 	 message about possibly exhausted resources.  */ | 
 |       if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\ | 
 | You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n"); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       target_terminal::ours_for_output (); | 
 |       error (("%s"), tmp_error_stream.c_str ()); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Used when the program stops. | 
 |    Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem | 
 |    removing a breakpoint location.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | remove_breakpoints (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   int val = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 |     if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner)) | 
 |       val |= remove_breakpoint (bl); | 
 |  | 
 |   return val; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to | 
 |    that thread.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | remove_threaded_breakpoints (thread_info *tp, | 
 | 			     std::optional<ULONGEST> /* exit_code */, | 
 | 			     int /* silent */) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (b.thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  gdb_printf (_("\ | 
 | Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"), | 
 | 		      b.number, print_thread_id (tp)); | 
 | 	  delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 |        } | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Called when inferior INF has been removed from GDB.  Remove associated | 
 |    per-inferior breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | remove_inferior_breakpoints (struct inferior *inf) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (b.inferior == inf->num && user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* Tell the user the breakpoint has been deleted.  But only for | 
 | 	     breakpoints that would not normally have been deleted at the | 
 | 	     next stop anyway.  */ | 
 | 	  if (b.disposition != disp_del | 
 | 	      && b.disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop) | 
 | 	    gdb_printf (_("\ | 
 | Inferior-specific breakpoint %d deleted - inferior %d has been removed.\n"), | 
 | 			b.number, inf->num); | 
 | 	  delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 |        } | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | remove_breakpoints_inf (inferior *inf) | 
 | { | 
 |   int val; | 
 |  | 
 |   breakpoint_debug_printf ("inf->num = %d", inf->num); | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  val = remove_breakpoint (bl); | 
 | 	  if (val != 0) | 
 | 	    return; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL. | 
 |    If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated | 
 |    from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented. | 
 |    Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from | 
 |    breakpoint_count and that value incremented.  Internal breakpoints | 
 |    do not set the internal var bpnum.  */ | 
 | static void | 
 | set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (internal) | 
 |     b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--; | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1); | 
 |       b->number = breakpoint_count; | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Create a TYPE breakpoint on ADDRESS from an object file with GDBARCH.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static struct breakpoint * | 
 | create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
 | 			    CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type) | 
 | { | 
 |   std::unique_ptr<internal_breakpoint> b | 
 |     (new internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, type, address)); | 
 |  | 
 |   b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--; | 
 |  | 
 |   return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b)); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Create a TYPE breakpoint on minimal symbol MSYM from an object file with | 
 |    GDBARCH.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static struct breakpoint * | 
 | create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
 | 			    bound_minimal_symbol &msym, enum bptype type) | 
 | { | 
 |   CORE_ADDR address; | 
 |  | 
 |   address = msym.value_address (); | 
 |  | 
 |   address = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr | 
 |     (gdbarch, address, current_inferior ()->top_target ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Note that we're not using gdbarch_addr_bits_remove here, because that's | 
 |      related to addresses in $pc.  We're getting the address from the | 
 |      minimal symbol table.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Is gdbarch_deprecated_function_start_offset needed here?  Or is that dealt | 
 |      with elsewhere?  Needs testing on vax.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   if (gdbarch_skip_entrypoint_p (gdbarch)) | 
 |     address = gdbarch_skip_entrypoint (gdbarch, address); | 
 |  | 
 |   return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, type); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static const char *const longjmp_names[] = | 
 |   { | 
 |     "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp" | 
 |   }; | 
 | #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names) | 
 |  | 
 | /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c.  */ | 
 | struct breakpoint_objfile_data | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any).  */ | 
 |   bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any).  */ | 
 |   bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES]; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes.  */ | 
 |   int longjmp_searched = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any).  These are non-owning | 
 |      references.  */ | 
 |   std::vector<probe *> longjmp_probes; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any).  */ | 
 |   bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any).  */ | 
 |   bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* True if we have looked for exception probes.  */ | 
 |   int exception_searched = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any).  These are non-owning | 
 |      references.  */ | 
 |   std::vector<probe *> exception_probes; | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | static const registry<objfile>::key<breakpoint_objfile_data> | 
 |   breakpoint_objfile_key; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel.  */ | 
 | static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym) | 
 | { | 
 |   return msym == &msym_not_found; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c. | 
 |    Allocate the data if necessary.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static struct breakpoint_objfile_data * | 
 | get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; | 
 |  | 
 |   bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.get (objfile); | 
 |   if (bp_objfile_data == NULL) | 
 |     bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.emplace (objfile); | 
 |   return bp_objfile_data; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event"; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (objfile &objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct breakpoint *b; | 
 |       struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; | 
 |       CORE_ADDR addr; | 
 |  | 
 |       bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (&objfile); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  bound_minimal_symbol m | 
 | 	    = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (current_program_space, func_name, | 
 | 					  &objfile); | 
 | 	  if (m.minsym == NULL) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile.  */ | 
 | 	      bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found; | 
 | 	      continue; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       addr = bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.value_address (); | 
 |       b = create_internal_breakpoint (objfile.arch (), addr, | 
 | 				      bp_overlay_event); | 
 |       b->locspec = new_explicit_location_spec_function (func_name); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  b->enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
 | 	  overlay_events_enabled = 1; | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 |        { | 
 | 	 b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
 | 	 overlay_events_enabled = 0; | 
 |        } | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Install a master longjmp breakpoint for OBJFILE using a probe.  Return | 
 |    true if a breakpoint was installed.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_probe (objfile *objfile) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct gdbarch *gdbarch = objfile->arch (); | 
 |   struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data | 
 |     = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched) | 
 |     { | 
 |       std::vector<probe *> ret | 
 | 	= find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp"); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!ret.empty ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* We are only interested in checking one element.  */ | 
 | 	  probe *p = ret[0]; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ()) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* We cannot use the probe interface here, | 
 | 		 because it does not know how to evaluate | 
 | 		 arguments.  */ | 
 | 	      ret.clear (); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |       bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret; | 
 |       bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes.empty ()) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct breakpoint *b; | 
 |  | 
 |       b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, | 
 | 				      p->get_relocated_address (objfile), | 
 | 				      bp_longjmp_master); | 
 |       b->locspec = new_probe_location_spec ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp"); | 
 |       b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return true; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Install master longjmp breakpoints for OBJFILE using longjmp_names. | 
 |    Return true if at least one breakpoint was installed.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_names (objfile *objfile) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct gdbarch *gdbarch = objfile->arch (); | 
 |   if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch)) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |  | 
 |   struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data | 
 |     = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); | 
 |   unsigned int installed_bp = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (int i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct breakpoint *b; | 
 |       const char *func_name; | 
 |       CORE_ADDR addr; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       func_name = longjmp_names[i]; | 
 |       if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  bound_minimal_symbol m | 
 | 	    = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (objfile->pspace (), func_name, | 
 | 					  objfile); | 
 | 	  if (m.minsym == NULL) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile.  */ | 
 | 	      bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found; | 
 | 	      continue; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       addr = bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].value_address (); | 
 |       b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master); | 
 |       b->locspec = new_explicit_location_spec_function (func_name); | 
 |       b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
 |       installed_bp++; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return installed_bp > 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Create a master longjmp breakpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (struct program_space *pspace : program_spaces) | 
 |     { | 
 |       set_current_program_space (pspace); | 
 |  | 
 |       for (objfile &obj : pspace->objfiles ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* Skip separate debug object, it's handled in the loop below.  */ | 
 | 	  if (obj.separate_debug_objfile_backlink != nullptr) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Try a probe kind breakpoint on main objfile.  */ | 
 | 	  if (create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_probe (&obj)) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Try longjmp_names kind breakpoints on main and separate_debug | 
 | 	     objfiles.  */ | 
 | 	  for (objfile *debug_objfile : obj.separate_debug_objfiles ()) | 
 | 	    if (create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_names (debug_objfile)) | 
 | 	      break; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint.  */ | 
 | static void | 
 | create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()"; | 
 |  | 
 |   scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace; | 
 |   scoped_restore_current_language save_language (language_cplus); | 
 |  | 
 |   for (struct program_space *pspace : program_spaces) | 
 |     { | 
 |       set_current_program_space (pspace); | 
 |  | 
 |       for (objfile &objfile : pspace->objfiles ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  struct breakpoint *b; | 
 | 	  struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (&objfile); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym)) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      bound_minimal_symbol m | 
 | 		= lookup_minimal_symbol (current_program_space, func_name, | 
 | 					 &objfile); | 
 | 	      if (m.minsym == NULL || (m.minsym->type () != mst_text | 
 | 				       && m.minsym->type () != mst_file_text)) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile.  */ | 
 | 		  bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found; | 
 | 		  continue; | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	      bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m; | 
 | 	    } | 
 |  | 
 | 	  b = create_internal_breakpoint (objfile.arch (), | 
 | 					  bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym, | 
 | 					  bp_std_terminate_master); | 
 | 	  b->locspec = new_explicit_location_spec_function (func_name); | 
 | 	  b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook for OBJFILE using a | 
 |    probe.  Return true if a breakpoint was installed.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | create_exception_master_breakpoint_probe (objfile *objfile) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct breakpoint *b; | 
 |   struct gdbarch *gdbarch; | 
 |   struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; | 
 |  | 
 |   bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists.  */ | 
 |   if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched) | 
 |     { | 
 |       std::vector<probe *> ret | 
 | 	= find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind"); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!ret.empty ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* We are only interested in checking one element.  */ | 
 | 	  probe *p = ret[0]; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ()) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does | 
 | 		 not know how to evaluate arguments.  */ | 
 | 	      ret.clear (); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |       bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret; | 
 |       bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bp_objfile_data->exception_probes.empty ()) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |  | 
 |   gdbarch = objfile->arch (); | 
 |  | 
 |   for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->exception_probes) | 
 |     { | 
 |       b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, | 
 | 				      p->get_relocated_address (objfile), | 
 | 				      bp_exception_master); | 
 |       b->locspec = new_probe_location_spec ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind"); | 
 |       b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return true; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook for OBJFILE using | 
 |    _Unwind_DebugHook.  Return true if a breakpoint was installed.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | create_exception_master_breakpoint_hook (objfile *objfile) | 
 | { | 
 |   const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook"; | 
 |   struct breakpoint *b; | 
 |   struct gdbarch *gdbarch; | 
 |   struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; | 
 |  | 
 |   bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym)) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |  | 
 |   gdbarch = objfile->arch (); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL) | 
 |     { | 
 |       bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook | 
 | 	= lookup_minimal_symbol_text (objfile->pspace (), func_name, objfile); | 
 |       if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found; | 
 | 	  return false; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_objfile_data->exception_msym, | 
 | 				  bp_exception_master); | 
 |   b->locspec = new_explicit_location_spec_function (func_name); | 
 |   b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
 |  | 
 |   return true; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | create_exception_master_breakpoint (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (objfile &obj : current_program_space->objfiles ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Skip separate debug object.  */ | 
 |       if (obj.separate_debug_objfile_backlink) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Try a probe kind breakpoint.  */ | 
 |       if (create_exception_master_breakpoint_probe (&obj)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Iterate over main and separate debug objects and try an | 
 | 	 _Unwind_DebugHook kind breakpoint.  */ | 
 |       for (objfile *debug_objfile : obj.separate_debug_objfiles ()) | 
 | 	if (create_exception_master_breakpoint_hook (debug_objfile)) | 
 | 	  break; | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Does B have a location spec?  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | breakpoint_location_spec_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   return (b->locspec != nullptr && b->locspec->empty_p ()); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | update_breakpoints_after_exec (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists.  If the | 
 |      INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by | 
 |      writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory.  The | 
 |      "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not | 
 |      do that.  Instead, the target is responsible from marking | 
 |      breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec.  We don't do that | 
 |      here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete | 
 |      breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here.  */ | 
 |   for (bp_location *bploc : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 |     if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space) | 
 |       gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted); | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (b.pspace != current_program_space) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec().  */ | 
 |       if (b.type == bp_shlib_event) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 | 	  continue; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec().  */ | 
 |       if (b.type == bp_jit_event) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 | 	  continue; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(), | 
 | 	 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints.  */ | 
 |       if (b.type == bp_thread_event || b.type == bp_overlay_event | 
 | 	  || b.type == bp_longjmp_master || b.type == bp_std_terminate_master | 
 | 	  || b.type == bp_exception_master) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 | 	  continue; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec().  */ | 
 |       if (b.type == bp_step_resume || b.type == bp_hp_step_resume) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 | 	  continue; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Just like single-step breakpoints.  */ | 
 |       if (b.type == bp_single_step) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 | 	  continue; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless | 
 | 	 after an exec.  */ | 
 |       if (b.type == bp_longjmp || b.type == bp_longjmp_resume | 
 | 	  || b.type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy | 
 | 	  || b.type == bp_exception || b.type == bp_exception_resume) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 | 	  continue; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (b.type == bp_catchpoint) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to | 
 | 	     do anything at this point.  In the future, if some of | 
 | 	     the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add | 
 | 	     a new method, and call this method from here.  */ | 
 | 	  continue; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* bp_finish is a special case.  The only way we ought to be able | 
 | 	 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user | 
 | 	 caught a vfork, and then said "finish".  Ordinarily a finish just | 
 | 	 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting | 
 | 	 a temporary bp there and resuming.  But in this case, the finish | 
 | 	 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec. | 
 |  | 
 | 	 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now.  But | 
 | 	 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to | 
 | 	 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it.  There's a | 
 | 	 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish | 
 | 	 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command | 
 | 	 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint. | 
 | 	 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish. | 
 |  | 
 | 	 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know | 
 | 	 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?" | 
 | 	 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and | 
 | 	 let finish_command delete it. | 
 |  | 
 | 	 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's | 
 | 	 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees | 
 | 	 the inferior stopped.  So it doesn't matter that the bp's | 
 | 	 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the | 
 | 	 solib breakpoints.)  */ | 
 |  | 
 |       if (b.type == bp_finish) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  continue; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the | 
 | 	 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec() | 
 | 	 a.out.  */ | 
 |       if (breakpoint_location_spec_empty_p (&b)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 | 	  continue; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid) | 
 | { | 
 |   int val = 0; | 
 |   scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid = make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid); | 
 |   struct inferior *inf = current_inferior (); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (ptid.pid () == inferior_ptid.pid ()) | 
 |     error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid")); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global.  */ | 
 |   inferior_ptid = ptid; | 
 |   for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations | 
 | 	 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint | 
 | 	 package's state.  Locations of type bp_loc_other and | 
 | 	 bp_loc_software_watchpoint are only maintained at GDB side, | 
 | 	 so there is no need to remove them.  Moreover, removing these | 
 | 	 would modify the breakpoint package's state.  */ | 
 |       if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other | 
 | 	  || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_watchpoint) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (bl->inserted) | 
 | 	val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return val; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space. | 
 |    Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork. | 
 |    When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither | 
 |    do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should | 
 |    *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static int | 
 | remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason) | 
 | { | 
 |   breakpoint_debug_printf ("%s due to %s", | 
 | 			   breakpoint_location_address_str (bl).c_str (), | 
 | 			   remove_bp_reason_str (reason)); | 
 |  | 
 |   int val; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted. | 
 |      This should not ever happen.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
 |       || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard | 
 | 	 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a | 
 | 	 bp_hardware_breakpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |       /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay.  */ | 
 |       if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off | 
 | 	  || bl->section == NULL | 
 | 	  || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section))) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we | 
 | 	     know is set in a dynamic object that is marked | 
 | 	     shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was | 
 | 	     removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with | 
 | 	     "nosharedlibrary".  In the former case, we don't know | 
 | 	     whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the | 
 | 	     breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know | 
 | 	     about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of | 
 | 	     add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a | 
 | 	     list of dynamically loaded objects).  If we have the | 
 | 	     breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software | 
 | 	     breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint | 
 | 	     is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong | 
 | 	     code with stale saved shadow contents.  Note that HW | 
 | 	     breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're | 
 | 	     implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on | 
 | 	     being able to modify the target's memory, and as such | 
 | 	     they should always be removed.  */ | 
 | 	  if (bl->shlib_disabled | 
 | 	      && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0 | 
 | 	      && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info)) | 
 | 	    val = 0; | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    val = bl->owner->remove_location (bl, reason); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section. | 
 | 	     Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA?  */ | 
 | 	  if (!overlay_events_enabled) | 
 | 	      { | 
 | 		/* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we | 
 | 		   should have set a breakpoint at the LMA.  Remove it.   | 
 | 		*/ | 
 | 		/* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will | 
 | 		   have already warned when we failed to insert it.  */ | 
 | 		if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 | 		  target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, | 
 | 					       &bl->overlay_target_info); | 
 | 		else | 
 | 		  target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, | 
 | 					    &bl->overlay_target_info, | 
 | 					    reason); | 
 | 	      } | 
 | 	  /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?  | 
 | 	     If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'.  */ | 
 | 	  if (bl->inserted) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Yes -- remove it.  Previously we did not bother to | 
 | 		 remove the breakpoint if the section had been | 
 | 		 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe.  We | 
 | 		 don't know what the overlay manager might do.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	      /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only | 
 | 		 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite | 
 | 		 wrong code with the saved shadow contents.  */ | 
 | 	      if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | 
 | 		  || section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | 
 | 		val = bl->owner->remove_location (bl, reason); | 
 | 	      else | 
 | 		val = 0; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove.  No error.  */ | 
 | 	      val = 0; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in | 
 | 	 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have | 
 | 	 not yet processed the shlib unload event.  Similarly for an | 
 | 	 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have | 
 | 	 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it.  shlib_disabled will | 
 | 	 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but | 
 | 	 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after | 
 | 	 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints | 
 | 	 always-inserted mode.  */ | 
 |       if (val | 
 | 	  && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
 | 	      && (bl->shlib_disabled | 
 | 		  || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address) | 
 | 		  || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace, | 
 | 							bl->address)))) | 
 | 	val = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (val) | 
 | 	return val; | 
 |       bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint) | 
 |     { | 
 |       bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT); | 
 |       bl->owner->remove_location (bl, reason); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here.  */ | 
 |       if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted) | 
 | 	warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."), | 
 | 		 bl->owner->number); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint | 
 | 	   && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner) | 
 | 	   && !bl->duplicate) | 
 |     { | 
 |       val = bl->owner->remove_location (bl, reason); | 
 |       if (val) | 
 | 	return val; | 
 |  | 
 |       bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static int | 
 | remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted. | 
 |      This should not ever happen.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none); | 
 |  | 
 |   scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | 
 |  | 
 |   switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace); | 
 |  | 
 |   return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | mark_breakpoints_out (program_space *pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 |     if (bl->pspace == pspace) | 
 |       bl->inserted = 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint_init_inferior (inferior *inf, inf_context context) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's | 
 |      nothing to do.  */ | 
 |   if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (inf->arch ())) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   mark_breakpoints_out (inf->pspace); | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (b.has_locations () && b.first_loc ().pspace != inf->pspace) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       switch (b.type) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	case bp_call_dummy: | 
 | 	case bp_longjmp_call_dummy: | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will | 
 | 	     cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get | 
 | 	     rid of it.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	case bp_watchpoint_scope: | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	case bp_shlib_event: | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Also remove solib event breakpoints.  Their addresses may | 
 | 	     have changed since the last time we ran the program. | 
 | 	     Actually we may now be debugging against different target; | 
 | 	     and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may | 
 | 	     not be used in by the target.  E.g., | 
 |  | 
 | 	     (gdb) file prog-linux | 
 | 	     (gdb) run               # native linux target | 
 | 	     ... | 
 | 	     (gdb) kill | 
 | 	     (gdb) file prog-win.exe | 
 | 	     (gdb) tar rem :9999     # remote Windows gdbserver. | 
 | 	  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	case bp_step_resume: | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	case bp_single_step: | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Also remove single-step breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	  delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 | 	  break; | 
 |  | 
 | 	case bp_watchpoint: | 
 | 	case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
 | 	case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
 | 	case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    watchpoint &w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint &> (b); | 
 |  | 
 | 	    /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions.  */ | 
 | 	    if (w.exp_valid_block != NULL) | 
 | 	      delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 | 	    else | 
 | 	      { | 
 | 		/* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer | 
 | 		   valid.  New ones will be created in | 
 | 		   update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted. | 
 | 		   The next update_global_location_list call will | 
 | 		   garbage collect them.  */ | 
 | 		b.clear_locations (); | 
 |  | 
 | 		if (context == inf_starting) | 
 | 		  { | 
 | 		    /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in | 
 | 		       insert_breakpoints.  */ | 
 | 		    w.val.reset (nullptr); | 
 | 		    w.val_valid = false; | 
 | 		  } | 
 | 	      } | 
 | 	  } | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	default: | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Get rid of the moribund locations.  */ | 
 |   for (bp_location *bl : moribund_locations) | 
 |     decref_bp_location (&bl); | 
 |   moribund_locations.clear (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the | 
 |    target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if | 
 |    we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space | 
 |    match, not program space.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint | 
 |    exists at PC.  It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an | 
 |    ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a | 
 |    permanent breakpoint. | 
 |    - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we | 
 |      actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints. | 
 |    - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we | 
 |      need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by | 
 |      the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | enum breakpoint_here | 
 | breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) | 
 | { | 
 |   bool any_breakpoint_here = false; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
 | 	  && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL.  */ | 
 |       if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner) | 
 | 	   || bl->permanent) | 
 | 	  && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (overlay_debugging  | 
 | 	      && section_is_overlay (bl->section) | 
 | 	      && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | 
 | 	    continue;		/* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */ | 
 | 	  else if (bl->permanent) | 
 | 	    return permanent_breakpoint_here; | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    any_breakpoint_here = true; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 		       CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
 | 	  && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner) | 
 | 	   || bl->permanent) | 
 | 	  && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace, | 
 | 							addr, len)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (overlay_debugging | 
 | 	      && section_is_overlay (bl->section) | 
 | 	      && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match.  */ | 
 | 	      continue; | 
 | 	    } | 
 |  | 
 | 	  return 1; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations) | 
 |     if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc)) | 
 |       return 1; | 
 |  | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Returns true iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space ASPACE.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | bp_location_inserted_here_p (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 			     const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (bl->inserted | 
 |       && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace.get (), bl->address, | 
 | 				   aspace, pc)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* An unmapped overlay can't be a match.  */ | 
 |       return !(overlay_debugging | 
 | 	       && section_is_overlay (bl->section) | 
 | 	       && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)); | 
 |     } | 
 |   return false; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
 | 	  && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc)) | 
 | 	return 1; | 
 |     } | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint | 
 |    inserted at PC.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 				     CORE_ADDR pc) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc)) | 
 | 	return 1; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 				     CORE_ADDR pc) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc)) | 
 | 	return 1; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 				       CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &bpt : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (bpt.type != bp_hardware_watchpoint | 
 | 	  && bpt.type != bp_access_watchpoint) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!breakpoint_enabled (&bpt)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       for (bp_location &loc : bpt.locations ()) | 
 | 	if (loc.pspace->aspace.get () == aspace && loc.inserted) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    CORE_ADDR l, h; | 
 |  | 
 | 	    /* Check for intersection.  */ | 
 | 	    l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc.address, addr); | 
 | 	    h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc.address + loc.length, addr + len); | 
 | 	    if (l < h) | 
 | 	      return 1; | 
 | 	  } | 
 |     } | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bool | 
 | is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   return (b->type == bp_catchpoint); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint. | 
 |    Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | bpstat_clear (bpstat **bsp) | 
 | { | 
 |   bpstat *p; | 
 |   bpstat *q; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bsp == 0) | 
 |     return; | 
 |   p = *bsp; | 
 |   while (p != NULL) | 
 |     { | 
 |       q = p->next; | 
 |       delete p; | 
 |       p = q; | 
 |     } | 
 |   *bsp = NULL; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | bpstat::bpstat (const bpstat &other) | 
 |   : next (NULL), | 
 |     bp_location_at (other.bp_location_at), | 
 |     breakpoint_at (other.breakpoint_at), | 
 |     commands (other.commands), | 
 |     print (other.print), | 
 |     stop (other.stop), | 
 |     print_it (other.print_it) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (other.old_val != NULL) | 
 |     old_val = release_value (other.old_val->copy ()); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return a copy of a bpstat.  Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that | 
 |    is part of the bpstat is copied as well.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bpstat * | 
 | bpstat_copy (bpstat *bs) | 
 | { | 
 |   bpstat *p = nullptr; | 
 |   bpstat *tmp; | 
 |   bpstat *retval = nullptr; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bs == NULL) | 
 |     return bs; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
 |     { | 
 |       tmp = new bpstat (*bs); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (p == NULL) | 
 | 	/* This is the first thing in the chain.  */ | 
 | 	retval = tmp; | 
 |       else | 
 | 	p->next = tmp; | 
 |       p = tmp; | 
 |     } | 
 |   p->next = NULL; | 
 |   return retval; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bpstat * | 
 | bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat *bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (bsp == NULL) | 
 |     return NULL; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint) | 
 | 	return bsp; | 
 |     } | 
 |   return NULL; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bool | 
 | bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat *bsp, enum gdb_signal sig) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than | 
 | 	     GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP.  */ | 
 | 	  if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) | 
 | 	    return true; | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (bsp->breakpoint_at->explains_signal (sig)) | 
 | 	    return true; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return false; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | bpstat_num (bpstat **bsp, int *num) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct breakpoint *b; | 
 |  | 
 |   if ((*bsp) == NULL) | 
 |     return 0;			/* No more breakpoint values */ | 
 |  | 
 |   /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a | 
 |      single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the | 
 |      same number more than once and this will look ugly.  */ | 
 |   b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at; | 
 |   *bsp = (*bsp)->next; | 
 |   if (b == NULL) | 
 |     return -1;			/* breakpoint that's been deleted since */ | 
 |  | 
 |   *num = b->number;		/* We have its number */ | 
 |   return 1; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | bpstat_locno (const bpstat *bs) | 
 | { | 
 |   const struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
 |   const struct bp_location *bl = bs->bp_location_at.get (); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (b != nullptr && b->has_multiple_locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       int locno = 1; | 
 |  | 
 |       for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (bl == &loc) | 
 | 	    return locno; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  ++locno; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       warning (_("location number not found for breakpoint %d address %s."), | 
 | 	       b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address)); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | print_num_locno (const bpstat *bs, struct ui_out *uiout) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (b == nullptr) | 
 |     uiout->text (_("deleted breakpoint")); | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number); | 
 |  | 
 |       int locno = bpstat_locno (bs); | 
 |       if (locno != 0) | 
 | 	uiout->message (".%pF", signed_field ("locno", locno)); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | bpstat_clear_actions (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   bpstat *bs; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   thread_info *tp = inferior_thread (); | 
 |   for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
 |     { | 
 |       bs->commands = NULL; | 
 |       bs->old_val.reset (nullptr); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (inferior_ptid != null_ptid) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread (); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not | 
 | 	 interrupt the command list.  When the call finishes | 
 | 	 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same | 
 | 	 breakpoint as if nothing happened.  */ | 
 |       if (tp->control.in_infcall) | 
 | 	return; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   breakpoint_proceeded = 1; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return true iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent' | 
 |    or its equivalent.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd) | 
 | { | 
 |   return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Sets the $_hit_bpnum and $_hit_locno to bpnum and locno. | 
 |    A locno 0 is changed to 1 to e.g. let the user do | 
 |      (gdb) disable $_hit_bpnum.$_hit_locno | 
 |    for a single location breakpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | set_hit_convenience_vars (int bpnum, int locno) | 
 | { | 
 |   set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("_hit_bpnum"), bpnum); | 
 |   set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("_hit_locno"), | 
 | 			   (locno > 0 ? locno : 1)); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at | 
 |    this location.  Any of these commands could cause the process to | 
 |    proceed beyond this point, etc.  We look out for such changes by | 
 |    checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command. | 
 |  | 
 |    Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior.  In that | 
 |    case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the | 
 |    bpstat of the current thread.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat **bsp) | 
 | { | 
 |   bpstat *bs; | 
 |   bool again = false; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained | 
 |      in bs->commands.  */ | 
 |   if (executing_breakpoint_commands) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |  | 
 |   scoped_restore save_executing | 
 |     = make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands, 1); | 
 |  | 
 |   scoped_restore preventer = prevent_dont_repeat (); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's.  */ | 
 |   bs = *bsp; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* The $_hit_* convenience variables are set before running the | 
 |      commands of BS.  In case we have several bs, after the loop, | 
 |      we set again the variables to the first printed bpnum and locno. | 
 |      For multiple breakpoints, this ensures the variables are set to the | 
 |      breakpoint printed for the user. */ | 
 |   int printed_hit_bpnum = -1; | 
 |   int printed_hit_locno = -1; | 
 |  | 
 |   breakpoint_proceeded = 0; | 
 |   for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct command_line *cmd = NULL; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Set the _hit_* convenience variables before running BS's commands.  */ | 
 |       { | 
 | 	const struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
 | 	if (b != nullptr) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    int locno = bpstat_locno (bs); | 
 |  | 
 | 	    set_hit_convenience_vars (b->number, locno); | 
 | 	    if (printed_hit_locno == -1 && bs->print) | 
 | 	      { | 
 | 		printed_hit_bpnum = b->number; | 
 | 		printed_hit_locno = locno; | 
 | 	      } | 
 | 	  } | 
 |       } | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one. | 
 |  | 
 | 	 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like | 
 | 	 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which | 
 | 	 frees the bpstat BS and its command tree.  To make sure this doesn't | 
 | 	 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to | 
 | 	 take ownership of the tree ourselves.  Since a given bpstat's | 
 | 	 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we | 
 | 	 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free | 
 | 	 the tree when we're done.  */ | 
 |       counted_command_line ccmd = bs->commands; | 
 |       bs->commands = NULL; | 
 |       if (ccmd != NULL) | 
 | 	cmd = ccmd.get (); | 
 |       if (command_line_is_silent (cmd)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status.  */ | 
 | 	  cmd = cmd->next; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       while (cmd != NULL) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  execute_control_command (cmd); | 
 | 	  /* After execute_control_command, if breakpoint_proceeded is true, | 
 | 	     BS has been freed and cannot be accessed anymore.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (breakpoint_proceeded) | 
 | 	    break; | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    cmd = cmd->next; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (breakpoint_proceeded) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (current_ui->async) | 
 | 	    /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still | 
 | 	       running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for | 
 | 	       us to do here -- just return to the event loop.  */ | 
 | 	    ; | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns | 
 | 	       we're already standing on the next breakpoint. | 
 | 	       Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since | 
 | 	       execute_command does not run breakpoint commands -- | 
 | 	       only command_line_handler does, but that one is not | 
 | 	       involved in execution of breakpoint commands.  So, we | 
 | 	       can now execute breakpoint commands.  It should be | 
 | 	       noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is | 
 | 	       not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive | 
 | 	       invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a | 
 | 	       command, and can easily blow up GDB stack.  Instead, we | 
 | 	       return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us | 
 | 	       with the new stop_bpstat.  */ | 
 | 	    again = true; | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Now that we have executed the commands of all bs, set the _hit_* | 
 |      convenience variables to the printed values.  */ | 
 |   if (printed_hit_locno != -1) | 
 |     set_hit_convenience_vars (printed_hit_bpnum, printed_hit_locno); | 
 |  | 
 |   return again; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Helper for bpstat_do_actions.  Get the current thread, if there's | 
 |    one, is alive and has execution.  Return NULL otherwise.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static thread_info * | 
 | get_bpstat_thread () | 
 | { | 
 |   if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ()) | 
 |     return NULL; | 
 |  | 
 |   thread_info *tp = inferior_thread (); | 
 |   if (tp->state == THREAD_EXITED || tp->executing ()) | 
 |     return NULL; | 
 |   return tp; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | bpstat_do_actions (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   auto cleanup_if_error = make_scope_exit (bpstat_clear_actions); | 
 |   thread_info *tp; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at.  */ | 
 |   while ((tp = get_bpstat_thread ()) != NULL) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the | 
 | 	 inferior, and only return when it is stopped at the next | 
 | 	 breakpoint, we keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns | 
 | 	 false to indicate the inferior was not resumed.  */ | 
 |       if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tp->control.stop_bpstat)) | 
 | 	break; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   cleanup_if_error.release (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (val == NULL) | 
 |     fprintf_styled (stream, metadata_style.style (), _("<unreadable>")); | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct value_print_options opts; | 
 |       get_user_print_options (&opts); | 
 |       value_print (val, stream, &opts); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if | 
 |    debugging multiple threads.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread (); | 
 |  | 
 |       uiout->text ("Thread "); | 
 |       uiout->field_string ("thread-id", print_thread_id (thr)); | 
 |  | 
 |       const char *name = thread_name (thr); | 
 |       if (name != NULL) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  uiout->text (" \""); | 
 | 	  uiout->field_string ("name", name); | 
 | 	  uiout->text ("\""); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       uiout->text (" hit "); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we | 
 |    stopped.  The behavior of this function depends on the value | 
 |    'print_it' in the bpstat structure.  Under some circumstances we | 
 |    may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to | 
 |    normal_stop().  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static enum print_stop_action | 
 | print_bp_stop_message (bpstat *bs) | 
 | { | 
 |   switch (bs->print_it) | 
 |     { | 
 |     case print_it_noop: | 
 |       /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry.  */ | 
 |       return PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
 |  | 
 |     case print_it_done: | 
 |       /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the | 
 | 	 relevant messages.  */ | 
 |       return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; | 
 |  | 
 |     case print_it_normal: | 
 |       { | 
 | 	struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
 |  | 
 | 	/* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint | 
 | 	   which has since been deleted.  */ | 
 | 	if (b == NULL) | 
 | 	  return PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
 |  | 
 | 	/* Normal case.  Call the breakpoint's print_it method.  */ | 
 | 	return b->print_it (bs); | 
 |       } | 
 |  | 
 |     default: | 
 |       internal_error (_("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value")); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | print_solib_event (bool is_catchpoint) | 
 | { | 
 |   bool any_deleted = !current_program_space->deleted_solibs.empty (); | 
 |   bool any_added = !current_program_space->added_solibs.empty (); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!is_catchpoint) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (any_added || any_deleted) | 
 | 	current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n")); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no " | 
 | 			       "libraries added or removed)\n")); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 |     current_uiout->field_string ("reason", | 
 | 				 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT)); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (any_deleted) | 
 |     { | 
 |       current_uiout->text (_("  Inferior unloaded ")); | 
 |       ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "removed"); | 
 |       for (int ix = 0; ix < current_program_space->deleted_solibs.size (); ix++) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  const std::string &name = current_program_space->deleted_solibs[ix]; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (ix > 0) | 
 | 	    current_uiout->text ("    "); | 
 | 	  current_uiout->field_string ("library", name); | 
 | 	  current_uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (any_added) | 
 |     { | 
 |       current_uiout->text (_("  Inferior loaded ")); | 
 |       ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "added"); | 
 |       bool first = true; | 
 |       for (solib *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (!first) | 
 | 	    current_uiout->text ("    "); | 
 | 	  first = false; | 
 | 	  current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->name); | 
 | 	  current_uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Print a message indicating what happened.  This is called from | 
 |    normal_stop().  The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat | 
 |    list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop.  KIND is | 
 |    the target_waitkind for the stopping event.  This | 
 |    routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message | 
 |    about reasons for stopping.  This will print (for example) the | 
 |    "Breakpoint n," part of the output.  The return value of this | 
 |    routine is one of: | 
 |  | 
 |    PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing. | 
 |    PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent | 
 |    code to print the location.  An example is  | 
 |    "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by | 
 |    the location. | 
 |    PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need | 
 |    to also print the location part of the message. | 
 |    An example is the catch/throw messages, which | 
 |    don't require a location appended to the end. | 
 |    PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any  | 
 |    further info to be printed.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | enum print_stop_action | 
 | bpstat_print (bpstat *bs, target_waitkind kind) | 
 | { | 
 |   enum print_stop_action val; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop. | 
 |      (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not. | 
 |      That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken | 
 |      with respect to bpstat_explains_signal).  */ | 
 |   for (; bs; bs = bs->next) | 
 |     { | 
 |       val = print_bp_stop_message (bs); | 
 |       if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY  | 
 | 	  || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC | 
 | 	  || val == PRINT_NOTHING) | 
 | 	return val; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint, | 
 |      print_bp_stop_message would print out this message.  If we hit an | 
 |      OS-level shared library event, do the same thing.  */ | 
 |   if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED) | 
 |     { | 
 |       print_solib_event (false); | 
 |       return PRINT_NOTHING; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start | 
 |      with and nothing was printed.  */ | 
 |   return PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | breakpoint_cond_eval (expression *exp) | 
 | { | 
 |   scoped_value_mark mark; | 
 |   return value_true (exp->evaluate ()); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Allocate a new bpstat.  Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bpstat::bpstat (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat ***bs_link_pointer) | 
 |   : next (NULL), | 
 |     bp_location_at (bp_location_ref_ptr::new_reference (bl)), | 
 |     breakpoint_at (bl->owner), | 
 |     commands (NULL), | 
 |     print (0), | 
 |     stop (0), | 
 |     print_it (print_it_normal) | 
 | { | 
 |   **bs_link_pointer = this; | 
 |   *bs_link_pointer = &next; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | bpstat::bpstat () | 
 |   : next (NULL), | 
 |     breakpoint_at (NULL), | 
 |     commands (NULL), | 
 |     print (0), | 
 |     stop (0), | 
 |     print_it (print_it_normal) | 
 | { | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS.  Check if any hardware | 
 |    watchpoints have triggered, according to the target.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | watchpoints_triggered (const target_waitstatus &ws) | 
 | { | 
 |   bool stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint (); | 
 |   CORE_ADDR addr; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!stopped_by_watchpoint) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint.  Mark all watchpoints | 
 | 	 as not triggered.  */ | 
 |       for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 | 	if (is_hardware_watchpoint (&b)) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    watchpoint &w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint &> (b); | 
 |  | 
 | 	    w.watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no; | 
 | 	  } | 
 |  | 
 |       return 0; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!target_stopped_data_address (current_inferior ()->top_target (), &addr)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where. | 
 | 	 Mark all watchpoints as unknown.  */ | 
 |       for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 | 	if (is_hardware_watchpoint (&b)) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    watchpoint &w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint &> (b); | 
 |  | 
 | 	    w.watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown; | 
 | 	  } | 
 |  | 
 |       return 1; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* The target could report the data address.  Mark watchpoints | 
 |      affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not | 
 |      triggered.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (is_hardware_watchpoint (&b)) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	watchpoint &w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint &> (b); | 
 |  | 
 | 	w.watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no; | 
 | 	for (bp_location &loc : b.locations ()) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    if (is_masked_watchpoint (&b)) | 
 | 	      { | 
 | 		CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w.hw_wp_mask; | 
 | 		CORE_ADDR start = loc.address & w.hw_wp_mask; | 
 |  | 
 | 		if (newaddr == start) | 
 | 		  { | 
 | 		    w.watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes; | 
 | 		    break; | 
 | 		  } | 
 | 	      } | 
 | 	    /* Exact match not required.  Within range is sufficient.  */ | 
 | 	    else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range | 
 | 		       (current_inferior ()->top_target (), addr, loc.address, | 
 | 			loc.length)) | 
 | 	      { | 
 | 		w.watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes; | 
 | 		break; | 
 | 	      } | 
 | 	  } | 
 |       } | 
 |  | 
 |   return 1; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check.  */ | 
 | enum wp_check_result | 
 |   { | 
 |     /* The watchpoint has been deleted.  */ | 
 |     WP_DELETED = 1, | 
 |  | 
 |     /* The value has changed.  */ | 
 |     WP_VALUE_CHANGED = 2, | 
 |  | 
 |     /* The value has not changed.  */ | 
 |     WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED = 3, | 
 |  | 
 |     /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not.  */ | 
 |     WP_IGNORE = 4, | 
 |   }; | 
 |  | 
 | #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1 | 
 | #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2 | 
 |  | 
 | /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value | 
 |    changed.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static wp_check_result | 
 | watchpoint_check (bpstat *bs) | 
 | { | 
 |   frame_info_ptr fr; | 
 |   bool within_current_scope; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL); | 
 |   watchpoint *b = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (bs->breakpoint_at); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the | 
 |      watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread | 
 |      that was used to create the watchpoint.  */ | 
 |   if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b)) | 
 |     return WP_IGNORE; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL) | 
 |     within_current_scope = true; | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       frame_info_ptr frame = get_current_frame (); | 
 |       struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame); | 
 |       CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're | 
 | 	 still in the function but the stack frame has already been | 
 | 	 invalidated.  Since we can't rely on the values of local | 
 | 	 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating | 
 | 	 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further | 
 | 	 checking.  Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current | 
 | 	 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other | 
 | 	 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and | 
 | 	 frame_find_by_id could error out.  */ | 
 |       if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc)) | 
 | 	return WP_IGNORE; | 
 |  | 
 |       fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame); | 
 |       within_current_scope = (fr != NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have | 
 | 	 returned a frame that can't describe this variable.  */ | 
 |       if (within_current_scope) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  struct symbol *function; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  function = get_frame_function (fr); | 
 | 	  if (function == NULL | 
 | 	      || !function->value_block ()->contains (b->exp_valid_block)) | 
 | 	    within_current_scope = false; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (within_current_scope) | 
 | 	/* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected | 
 | 	   in normal_stop.  So this call to select_frame won't affect | 
 | 	   the user.  */ | 
 | 	select_frame (fr); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (within_current_scope) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long* | 
 | 	 time before we return to the command level and call | 
 | 	 free_all_values.  We can't call free_all_values because we | 
 | 	 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |       struct value *mark; | 
 |       struct value *new_val; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (is_masked_watchpoint (b)) | 
 | 	/* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from | 
 | 	   stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered | 
 | 	   a mask watchpoint.  */ | 
 | 	return WP_VALUE_CHANGED; | 
 |  | 
 |       mark = value_mark (); | 
 |       fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), b->exp->op.get (), &new_val, | 
 | 			  NULL, NULL, false); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (b->val_bitsize != 0) | 
 | 	new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because | 
 | 	 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just | 
 | 	 the address of the array instead of its contents.  This is | 
 | 	 not what we want.  */ | 
 |       if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL) | 
 | 	  || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val.get (), | 
 | 						       new_val))) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  bs->old_val = b->val; | 
 | 	  b->val = release_value (new_val); | 
 | 	  b->val_valid = true; | 
 | 	  if (new_val != NULL) | 
 | 	    value_free_to_mark (mark); | 
 | 	  return WP_VALUE_CHANGED; | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* Nothing changed.  */ | 
 | 	  value_free_to_mark (mark); | 
 | 	  return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because | 
 | 	 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when | 
 | 	 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains | 
 | 	 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two | 
 | 	 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue). | 
 | 	 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and | 
 | 	 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal | 
 | 	 the first value assigned).  */ | 
 |       /* We print all the stop information in | 
 | 	 breakpointprint_it, but in this case, by the time we | 
 | 	 call breakpoint->print_it this bp will be deleted | 
 | 	 already.  So we have no choice but print the information | 
 | 	 here.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |       SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS () | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 | 	    uiout->field_string | 
 | 	      ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE)); | 
 | 	  uiout->message ("\nWatchpoint %pF deleted because the program has " | 
 | 			  "left the block in\n" | 
 | 			  "which its expression is valid.\n", | 
 | 			  signed_field ("wpnum", b->number)); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed.  */ | 
 |       b->commands = NULL; | 
 |       watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b); | 
 |  | 
 |       return WP_DELETED; | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting | 
 |    breakpoint location BL.  This function does not check if we should | 
 |    stop, only if BL explains the stop.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 		       const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
 | 		       const target_waitstatus &ws) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* BL is from an existing breakpoint.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (b != NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   return b->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we | 
 |    should stop.  If not, set BS->stop to false.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat *bs) | 
 | { | 
 |   const struct bp_location *bl; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint.  */ | 
 |   bl = bs->bp_location_at.get (); | 
 |   gdb_assert (bl != NULL); | 
 |   watchpoint *b = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (bs->breakpoint_at); | 
 |  | 
 |   bool must_check_value = false; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (b->type == bp_watchpoint) | 
 |     /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the | 
 |        watched value.  */ | 
 |     must_check_value = true; | 
 |   else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes) | 
 |     /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access) | 
 |        and the target earlier reported an address watched by | 
 |        this watchpoint.  */ | 
 |     must_check_value = true; | 
 |   else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown | 
 | 	   && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint) | 
 |     /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could | 
 |        not report the data address.  We must check the watchpoint's | 
 |        value.  Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without | 
 |        a data address, we can't figure it out.  */ | 
 |     must_check_value = true; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (must_check_value) | 
 |     { | 
 |       wp_check_result e; | 
 |  | 
 |       try | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  e = watchpoint_check (bs); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex, | 
 | 			     "Error evaluating expression " | 
 | 			     "for watchpoint %d\n", | 
 | 			     b->number); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS () | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      gdb_printf (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), | 
 | 			  b->number); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b); | 
 | 	  e = WP_DELETED; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       switch (e) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	case WP_DELETED: | 
 | 	  /* We've already printed what needs to be printed.  */ | 
 | 	  bs->print_it = print_it_done; | 
 | 	  /* Stop.  */ | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case WP_IGNORE: | 
 | 	  bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | 
 | 	  bs->stop = false; | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case WP_VALUE_CHANGED: | 
 | 	  if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* There are two cases to consider here: | 
 |  | 
 | 		 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads. | 
 | 		 In that case, trust the target, and always report | 
 | 		 the watchpoint hit to the user.  Even though | 
 | 		 reads don't cause value changes, the value may | 
 | 		 have changed since the last time it was read, and | 
 | 		 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see | 
 | 		 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of | 
 | 		 old value. | 
 |  | 
 | 		 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both | 
 | 		 reads and writes.  There are two ways this may | 
 | 		 happen: | 
 |  | 
 | 		 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data | 
 | 		 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or | 
 | 		 writes), such as e.g., x86.  We detect this case | 
 | 		 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints. | 
 |  | 
 | 		 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read | 
 | 		 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write | 
 | 		 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read | 
 | 		 watchpoint. | 
 |  | 
 | 		 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads, | 
 | 		 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the | 
 | 		 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause | 
 | 		 changes.  This still gives false positives when | 
 | 		 the program writes the same value to memory as | 
 | 		 what there was already in memory (we will confuse | 
 | 		 it for a read), but it's much better than | 
 | 		 nothing.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	      int other_write_watchpoint = 0; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  for (breakpoint &other_b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 | 		    if (other_b.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint | 
 | 			|| other_b.type == bp_access_watchpoint) | 
 | 		      { | 
 | 			watchpoint &other_w = | 
 | 			  gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint &> (other_b); | 
 |  | 
 | 			if (other_w.watchpoint_triggered | 
 | 			    == watch_triggered_yes) | 
 | 			  { | 
 | 			    other_write_watchpoint = 1; | 
 | 			    break; | 
 | 			  } | 
 | 		      } | 
 | 		} | 
 |  | 
 | 	      if (other_write_watchpoint | 
 | 		  || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  /* We're watching the same memory for writes, | 
 | 		     and the value changed since the last time we | 
 | 		     updated it, so this trap must be for a write. | 
 | 		     Ignore it.  */ | 
 | 		  bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | 
 | 		  bs->stop = false; | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED: | 
 | 	  if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint | 
 | 	      || b->type == bp_watchpoint) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if | 
 | 		 the value hasn't changed.  */ | 
 | 	      bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | 
 | 	      bs->stop = false; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  /* Stop.  */ | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	default: | 
 | 	  /* Can't happen.  */ | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |   else	/* !must_check_value */ | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but | 
 | 	 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no | 
 | 	 watchpoint triggered after all.  So don't print | 
 | 	 anything for this watchpoint.  */ | 
 |       bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | 
 |       bs->stop = false; | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop, | 
 |    check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count) | 
 |    of breakpoint referred to by BS.  If we should not stop for this | 
 |    breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat *bs, thread_info *thread) | 
 | { | 
 |   INFRUN_SCOPED_DEBUG_ENTER_EXIT; | 
 |  | 
 |   const struct bp_location *bl; | 
 |   struct breakpoint *b; | 
 |   /* Assume stop.  */ | 
 |   bool condition_result = true; | 
 |   struct expression *cond; | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_assert (bs->stop); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint.  */ | 
 |   bl = bs->bp_location_at.get (); | 
 |   gdb_assert (bl != NULL); | 
 |   b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
 |   gdb_assert (b != NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   infrun_debug_printf ("thread = %s, breakpoint %d.%d", | 
 | 		       thread->ptid.to_string ().c_str (), | 
 | 		       b->number, find_loc_num_by_location (bl)); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we | 
 |      need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a | 
 |      breakpoint or a single step breakpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id) | 
 |       && b->frame_id != get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())) | 
 |     { | 
 |       infrun_debug_printf ("incorrect frame %s not %s, not stopping", | 
 | 			   get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ()).to_string ().c_str (), | 
 | 			   b->frame_id.to_string ().c_str ()); | 
 |       bs->stop = false; | 
 |       return; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu | 
 |      evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified | 
 |      thread/task.  */ | 
 |   if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread->global_num) | 
 |       || (b->inferior != -1 && b->inferior != thread->inf->num) | 
 |       || (b->task != -1 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (thread))) | 
 |     { | 
 |       infrun_debug_printf ("incorrect thread or task, not stopping"); | 
 |       bs->stop = false; | 
 |       return; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method | 
 |      implemented.  */ | 
 |   bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (is_watchpoint (b)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       watchpoint *w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (b); | 
 |  | 
 |       cond = w->cond_exp.get (); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     cond = bl->cond.get (); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (cond != nullptr && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop) | 
 |     { | 
 |       bool within_current_scope = true; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* We use scoped_value_mark because it could be a long time | 
 | 	 before we return to the command level and call | 
 | 	 free_all_values.  We can't call free_all_values because we | 
 | 	 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call.  */ | 
 |       scoped_value_mark mark; | 
 |  | 
 |       watchpoint *w = nullptr; | 
 |       if (is_watchpoint (b)) | 
 | 	w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (b); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that | 
 | 	 the conditions will have the right context.  Because we | 
 | 	 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's | 
 | 	 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start | 
 | 	 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the | 
 | 	 call site.  */ | 
 |       if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL) | 
 | 	select_frame (get_current_frame ()); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  frame_info_ptr frame; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular | 
 | 	     instance of a local is being watched matters, so we | 
 | 	     keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression | 
 | 	     in.  To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't | 
 | 	     really matter which instantiation of the function | 
 | 	     where the condition makes sense triggers the | 
 | 	     watchpoint.  This allows an expression like "watch | 
 | 	     global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to | 
 | 	     global on all threads that call `func', or catch | 
 | 	     writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single | 
 | 	     thread.  We simply always evaluate the condition in | 
 | 	     the innermost frame that's executing where it makes | 
 | 	     sense to evaluate the condition.  It seems | 
 | 	     intuitive.  */ | 
 | 	  frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block); | 
 | 	  if (frame != NULL) | 
 | 	    select_frame (frame); | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    within_current_scope = false; | 
 | 	} | 
 |       if (within_current_scope) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  try | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      scoped_restore reset_in_cond_eval | 
 | 		= make_scoped_restore (&thread->control.in_cond_eval, true); | 
 | 	      condition_result = breakpoint_cond_eval (cond); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      int locno = bpstat_locno (bs); | 
 | 	      if (locno != 0) | 
 | 		exception_fprintf | 
 | 		  (gdb_stderr, ex, | 
 | 		   "Error in testing condition for breakpoint %d.%d:\n", | 
 | 		   b->number, locno); | 
 | 	      else | 
 | 		exception_fprintf | 
 | 		  (gdb_stderr, ex, | 
 | 		   "Error in testing condition for breakpoint %d:\n", | 
 | 		   b->number); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested " | 
 | 		     "in the current scope")); | 
 | 	  /* If we failed to set the right context for this | 
 | 	     watchpoint, unconditionally report it.  */ | 
 | 	} | 
 |       /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #.  */ | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (cond != nullptr && !condition_result) | 
 |     { | 
 |       infrun_debug_printf ("condition_result = false, not stopping"); | 
 |       bs->stop = false; | 
 |       return; | 
 |     } | 
 |   else if (b->ignore_count > 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       infrun_debug_printf ("ignore count %d, not stopping", | 
 | 			   b->ignore_count); | 
 |       b->ignore_count--; | 
 |       bs->stop = false; | 
 |       /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop.  */ | 
 |       ++(b->hit_count); | 
 |       notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
 |       return; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bs->stop) | 
 |     infrun_debug_printf ("stopping at this breakpoint"); | 
 |   else | 
 |     infrun_debug_printf ("not stopping at this breakpoint"); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type | 
 |    on the current target.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | need_moribund_for_location_type (const struct bp_location *loc) | 
 | { | 
 |   return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
 | 	   && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()) | 
 | 	  || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | 
 | 	      && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bpstat * | 
 | build_bpstat_chain (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
 | 		    const target_waitstatus &ws) | 
 | { | 
 |   bpstat *bs_head = nullptr, **bs_link = &bs_head; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (!breakpoint_enabled (&b)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       for (bp_location &bl : b.locations ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first | 
 | 	     location.  The watchpoint_check function will work on the | 
 | 	     entire expression, not the individual locations.  For | 
 | 	     read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has | 
 | 	     checked all locations already.  */ | 
 | 	  if (b.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && &bl != &b.first_loc ()) | 
 | 	    break; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (!bl.enabled || bl.disabled_by_cond || bl.shlib_disabled) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (!bpstat_check_location (&bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws)) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address | 
 | 	     matches.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	  bpstat *bs = new bpstat (&bl, &bs_link);	/* Alloc a bpstat to | 
 | 							   explain stop.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Assume we stop.  Should we find a watchpoint that is not | 
 | 	     actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint | 
 | 	     evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0.  */ | 
 | 	  bs->stop = true; | 
 | 	  bs->print = true; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated | 
 | 	     watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the | 
 | 	     out-of-scope event.  We'll get to the watchpoint next | 
 | 	     iteration.  */ | 
 | 	  if (b.type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b.related_breakpoint != &b) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      watchpoint *w | 
 | 		= gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (b.related_breakpoint); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop.  */ | 
 |   if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint () | 
 |       || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr) | 
 | 	      && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc)) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      bpstat *bs = new bpstat (loc, &bs_link); | 
 | 	      /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed.  */ | 
 | 	      bs->stop = false; | 
 | 	      bs->print = false; | 
 | 	      bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return bs_head; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bpstat * | 
 | bpstat_stop_status (const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 		    CORE_ADDR bp_addr, thread_info *thread, | 
 | 		    const target_waitstatus &ws, | 
 | 		    bpstat *stop_chain) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct breakpoint *b = NULL; | 
 |   /* First item of allocated bpstat's.  */ | 
 |   bpstat *bs_head = stop_chain; | 
 |   bpstat *bs; | 
 |   int need_remove_insert; | 
 |   int removed_any; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a | 
 |      target stop, while being careful to not set the target running, | 
 |      as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint | 
 |      locations are recreated).  Resuming will happen here with | 
 |      breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include | 
 |      inferior function calls.  */ | 
 |   if (bs_head == NULL) | 
 |     bs_head = build_bpstat_chain (aspace, bp_addr, ws); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints.  We need to | 
 |      process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and | 
 |      unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and | 
 |      "catch unload".  */ | 
 |   for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  handle_solib_event (); | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and | 
 |      check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher | 
 |      layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   removed_any = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (!bs->stop) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
 |       b->check_status (bs); | 
 |       if (bs->stop) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, thread); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (bs->stop) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      ++(b->hit_count); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      /* We will stop here.  */ | 
 | 	      if (b->disposition == disp_disable) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  --(b->enable_count); | 
 | 		  if (b->enable_count <= 0) | 
 | 		    b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
 | 		  removed_any = 1; | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	      notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
 | 	      if (b->silent) | 
 | 		bs->print = false; | 
 | 	      bs->commands = b->commands; | 
 | 	      if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands | 
 | 					  ? bs->commands.get () : NULL)) | 
 | 		bs->print = false; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      b->after_condition_true (bs); | 
 | 	    } | 
 |  | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't | 
 | 	 print.  */ | 
 |       if (!bs->stop || !bs->print) | 
 | 	bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may | 
 |      not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are | 
 |      watching may have.  Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get | 
 |      done later.  */ | 
 |   need_remove_insert = 0; | 
 |   if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head)) | 
 |     for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
 |       if (!bs->stop | 
 | 	  && bs->breakpoint_at | 
 | 	  && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  watchpoint *w | 
 | 	    = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (bs->breakpoint_at); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  update_watchpoint (w, false /* don't reparse.  */); | 
 | 	  need_remove_insert = 1; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |   if (need_remove_insert) | 
 |     update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
 |   else if (removed_any) | 
 |     update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
 |  | 
 |   return bs_head; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bpstat * | 
 | bpstat_stop_status_nowatch (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
 | 			    thread_info *thread, const target_waitstatus &ws) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_assert (!target_stopped_by_watchpoint ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Clear all watchpoints' 'watchpoint_triggered' value from a | 
 |      previous stop to avoid confusing bpstat_stop_status.  */ | 
 |   watchpoints_triggered (ws); | 
 |  | 
 |   return bpstat_stop_status (aspace, bp_addr, thread, ws); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | handle_jit_event (CORE_ADDR address) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct gdbarch *gdbarch; | 
 |  | 
 |   infrun_debug_printf ("handling bp_jit_event"); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by | 
 |      breakpoint_re_set.  */ | 
 |   target_terminal::ours_for_output (); | 
 |  | 
 |   gdbarch = get_frame_arch (get_current_frame ()); | 
 |   /* This event is caused by a breakpoint set in `jit_breakpoint_re_set`, | 
 |      thus it is expected that its objectfile can be found through | 
 |      minimal symbol lookup.  If it doesn't work (and assert fails), it | 
 |      most likely means that `jit_breakpoint_re_set` was changes and this | 
 |      function needs to be updated too.  */ | 
 |   bound_minimal_symbol jit_bp_sym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (address); | 
 |   gdb_assert (jit_bp_sym.objfile != nullptr); | 
 |   objfile *objfile = jit_bp_sym.objfile; | 
 |   if (objfile->separate_debug_objfile_backlink) | 
 |     objfile = objfile->separate_debug_objfile_backlink; | 
 |   jit_event_handler (gdbarch, objfile); | 
 |  | 
 |   target_terminal::inferior (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | struct bpstat_what | 
 | bpstat_what (bpstat *bs_head) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct bpstat_what retval; | 
 |   bpstat *bs; | 
 |  | 
 |   retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING; | 
 |   retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE; | 
 |   retval.is_longjmp = false; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Extract this BS's action.  After processing each BS, we check | 
 | 	 if its action overrides all we've seem so far.  */ | 
 |       enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING; | 
 |       enum bptype bptype; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary | 
 | 	     breakpoint which has since been deleted.  */ | 
 | 	  bptype = bp_none; | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type; | 
 |  | 
 |       switch (bptype) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	case bp_none: | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_breakpoint: | 
 | 	case bp_hardware_breakpoint: | 
 | 	case bp_single_step: | 
 | 	case bp_until: | 
 | 	case bp_finish: | 
 | 	case bp_shlib_event: | 
 | 	  if (bs->stop) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      if (bs->print) | 
 | 		this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY; | 
 | 	      else | 
 | 		this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_watchpoint: | 
 | 	case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
 | 	case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
 | 	case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
 | 	  if (bs->stop) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      if (bs->print) | 
 | 		this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY; | 
 | 	      else | 
 | 		this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping. | 
 | 		 This requires no further action.  */ | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_longjmp: | 
 | 	case bp_longjmp_call_dummy: | 
 | 	case bp_exception: | 
 | 	  if (bs->stop) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME; | 
 | 	      retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_longjmp_resume: | 
 | 	case bp_exception_resume: | 
 | 	  if (bs->stop) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME; | 
 | 	      retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_step_resume: | 
 | 	  if (bs->stop) | 
 | 	    this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME; | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* It is for the wrong frame.  */ | 
 | 	      this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_hp_step_resume: | 
 | 	  if (bs->stop) | 
 | 	    this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME; | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* It is for the wrong frame.  */ | 
 | 	      this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_watchpoint_scope: | 
 | 	case bp_thread_event: | 
 | 	case bp_overlay_event: | 
 | 	case bp_longjmp_master: | 
 | 	case bp_std_terminate_master: | 
 | 	case bp_exception_master: | 
 | 	  this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_catchpoint: | 
 | 	  if (bs->stop) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      if (bs->print) | 
 | 		this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY; | 
 | 	      else | 
 | 		this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Some catchpoints are implemented with breakpoints. | 
 | 		 For those, we need to step over the breakpoint.  */ | 
 | 	      if (bs->bp_location_at->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
 | 		  || bs->bp_location_at->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 | 		this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_jit_event: | 
 | 	  this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_call_dummy: | 
 | 	  /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy), | 
 | 	     so infrun.c pops the dummy frame.  */ | 
 | 	  retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY; | 
 | 	  this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_std_terminate: | 
 | 	  /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy), | 
 | 	     so infrun.c pops the dummy frame.  */ | 
 | 	  retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE; | 
 | 	  this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_tracepoint: | 
 | 	case bp_fast_tracepoint: | 
 | 	case bp_static_tracepoint: | 
 | 	case bp_static_marker_tracepoint: | 
 | 	  /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and | 
 | 	     if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered | 
 | 	     out already.  */ | 
 | 	  internal_error (_("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered")); | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: | 
 | 	  /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return).  */ | 
 | 	  this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return: | 
 | 	  /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the | 
 | 	     PC of the former breakpoint.  */ | 
 | 	  this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING; | 
 | 	  break; | 
 |  | 
 | 	case bp_dprintf: | 
 | 	  if (bs->stop) | 
 | 	    this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
 | 	  break; | 
 |  | 
 | 	default: | 
 | 	  internal_error (_("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return retval; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat *bs_head) | 
 | { | 
 |   bpstat *bs; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (b == NULL) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |       switch (b->type) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	case bp_jit_event: | 
 | 	  handle_jit_event (bs->bp_location_at->address); | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: | 
 | 	  gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop | 
 | 	    (gdb::checked_static_cast<code_breakpoint *> (b)); | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return: | 
 | 	  gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop | 
 | 	    (gdb::checked_static_cast<code_breakpoint *> (b)); | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bool | 
 | bpstat_should_step () | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (breakpoint_enabled (&b) | 
 | 	&& b.type == bp_watchpoint | 
 | 	&& b.has_locations ()) | 
 |       return true; | 
 |  | 
 |   return false; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bool | 
 | bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat *bs) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
 |     if (bs->stop) | 
 |       return true; | 
 |  | 
 |   return false; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 | /* Compute a number of spaces suitable to indent the next line | 
 |    so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column | 
 |    named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static int | 
 | wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name) | 
 | { | 
 |   int i, total_width, width, align; | 
 |   const char *text; | 
 |  | 
 |   total_width = 0; | 
 |   for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0) | 
 | 	return total_width; | 
 |  | 
 |       total_width += width + 1; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions | 
 |    evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both.  Returns the following: | 
 |  | 
 |     "host": Host evals condition. | 
 |     "host or target": Host or Target evals condition. | 
 |     "target": Target evals condition. | 
 | */ | 
 |  | 
 | static const char * | 
 | bp_condition_evaluator (const breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   char host_evals = 0; | 
 |   char target_evals = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!b) | 
 |     return NULL; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!is_breakpoint (b)) | 
 |     return NULL; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | 
 |       || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
 |     return condition_evaluation_host; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bp_location &bl : b->locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (bl.cond_bytecode) | 
 | 	target_evals++; | 
 |       else | 
 | 	host_evals++; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (host_evals && target_evals) | 
 |     return condition_evaluation_both; | 
 |   else if (target_evals) | 
 |     return condition_evaluation_target; | 
 |   else | 
 |     return condition_evaluation_host; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator.  This is | 
 |    similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static const char * | 
 | bp_location_condition_evaluator (const struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner)) | 
 |     return NULL; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | 
 |       || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
 |     return condition_evaluation_host; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode) | 
 |     return condition_evaluation_target; | 
 |   else | 
 |     return condition_evaluation_host; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | print_breakpoint_location (const breakpoint *b, const bp_location *loc) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |  | 
 |   scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled) | 
 |     loc = NULL; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (loc != NULL) | 
 |     set_current_program_space (loc->pspace); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (b->display_canonical) | 
 |     uiout->field_string ("what", b->locspec->to_string ()); | 
 |   else if (loc && loc->symtab) | 
 |     { | 
 |       const struct symbol *sym = loc->symbol; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (sym) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  uiout->text ("in "); | 
 | 	  uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (), | 
 | 			       function_name_style.style ()); | 
 | 	  uiout->text (" "); | 
 | 	  uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what")); | 
 | 	  uiout->text ("at "); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       uiout->field_string ("file", | 
 | 			   symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab), | 
 | 			   file_name_style.style ()); | 
 |       uiout->text (":"); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 | 	uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab)); | 
 |        | 
 |       uiout->field_signed ("line", loc->line_number, | 
 | 			   line_number_style.style ()); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else if (loc) | 
 |     { | 
 |       string_file stb; | 
 |  | 
 |       print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, &stb, | 
 | 			      demangle, ""); | 
 |       uiout->field_stream ("at", stb); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Internal breakpoints don't have a locspec string, but can become | 
 | 	 pending if the shared library the breakpoint is in is unloaded. | 
 | 	 For most internal breakpoint types though, after unloading the | 
 | 	 shared library, the breakpoint will be deleted and never recreated | 
 | 	 (see internal_breakpoint::re_set).  But for two internal | 
 | 	 breakpoint types bp_shlib_event and bp_thread_event this is not | 
 | 	 true.  Usually we don't expect the libraries that contain these | 
 | 	 breakpoints to ever be unloaded, but a buggy inferior might do | 
 | 	 such a thing, in which case GDB should be prepared to handle this | 
 | 	 case. | 
 |  | 
 | 	 If these two breakpoint types become pending then there will be no | 
 | 	 locspec string.  */ | 
 |       gdb_assert (b->locspec != nullptr | 
 | 		  || (!user_breakpoint_p (b) | 
 | 		      && (b->type == bp_shlib_event | 
 | 			  || b->type == bp_thread_event))); | 
 |       const char *locspec_str | 
 | 	= (b->locspec != nullptr ? b->locspec->to_string () : ""); | 
 |       uiout->field_string ("pending", locspec_str); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (loc && is_breakpoint (b) | 
 |       && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target | 
 |       && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both) | 
 |     { | 
 |       uiout->text (" ("); | 
 |       uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by", | 
 | 			   bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc)); | 
 |       uiout->text (")"); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static const char * | 
 | bptype_string (enum bptype type) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct ep_type_description | 
 |     { | 
 |       enum bptype type; | 
 |       const char *description; | 
 |     }; | 
 |   static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] = | 
 |   { | 
 |     {bp_none, "?deleted?"}, | 
 |     {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"}, | 
 |     {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"}, | 
 |     {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"}, | 
 |     {bp_until, "until"}, | 
 |     {bp_finish, "finish"}, | 
 |     {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"}, | 
 |     {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"}, | 
 |     {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"}, | 
 |     {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"}, | 
 |     {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"}, | 
 |     {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"}, | 
 |     {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"}, | 
 |     {bp_exception, "exception"}, | 
 |     {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"}, | 
 |     {bp_step_resume, "step resume"}, | 
 |     {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"}, | 
 |     {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"}, | 
 |     {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"}, | 
 |     {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"}, | 
 |     {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"}, | 
 |     {bp_thread_event, "thread events"}, | 
 |     {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"}, | 
 |     {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"}, | 
 |     {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"}, | 
 |     {bp_exception_master, "exception master"}, | 
 |     {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"}, | 
 |     {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"}, | 
 |     {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"}, | 
 |     {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"}, | 
 |     {bp_static_marker_tracepoint, "static marker tracepoint"}, | 
 |     {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"}, | 
 |     {bp_jit_event, "jit events"}, | 
 |     {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"}, | 
 |     {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"}, | 
 |   }; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0]))) | 
 |       || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type)) | 
 |     internal_error (_("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."), | 
 | 		    (int) type); | 
 |  | 
 |   return bptypes[(int) type].description; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value. | 
 |    For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout, | 
 | 		      const char *field_name, | 
 | 		      const std::vector<int> &inf_nums, | 
 | 		      int mi_only) | 
 | { | 
 |   int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p (); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless | 
 |      there are several.  Always display them for MI. */ | 
 |   if (!is_mi && mi_only) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (uiout, field_name); | 
 |  | 
 |   for (size_t i = 0; i < inf_nums.size (); i++) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (is_mi) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  char mi_group[10]; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf_nums[i]); | 
 | 	  uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (i == 0) | 
 | 	    uiout->text (" inf "); | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    uiout->text (", "); | 
 | 	 | 
 | 	  uiout->text (plongest (inf_nums[i])); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | 
 |  | 
 | bool fix_breakpoint_script_output_globally = false; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Print B to gdb_stdout.  If RAW_LOC, print raw breakpoint locations | 
 |    instead of going via breakpoint_ops::print_one.  This makes "maint | 
 |    info breakpoints" show the software breakpoint locations of | 
 |    catchpoints, which are considered internal implementation | 
 |    detail.  Returns true if RAW_LOC is false and if the breakpoint's | 
 |    print_one method did something; false otherwise.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b, | 
 | 			       struct bp_location *loc, | 
 | 			       int loc_number, | 
 | 			       const bp_location **last_loc, | 
 | 			       int allflag, bool raw_loc) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct command_line *l; | 
 |   static char bpenables[] = "nynny"; | 
 |  | 
 |   struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |   bool header_of_multiple = false; | 
 |   bool part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL); | 
 |   struct value_print_options opts; | 
 |  | 
 |   get_user_print_options (&opts); | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0); | 
 |   /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of | 
 |      breakpoints with single disabled location.  */ | 
 |   if (loc == NULL  | 
 |       && (b->has_locations () | 
 | 	  && (b->has_multiple_locations () | 
 | 	      || !b->first_loc ().enabled || b->first_loc ().disabled_by_cond))) | 
 |     header_of_multiple = true; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (loc == NULL && b->has_locations ()) | 
 |     loc = &b->first_loc (); | 
 |  | 
 |   annotate_record (); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* 1 */ | 
 |   annotate_field (0); | 
 |   if (part_of_multiple) | 
 |     uiout->field_fmt ("number", "%d.%d", b->number, loc_number); | 
 |   else | 
 |     uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* 2 */ | 
 |   annotate_field (1); | 
 |   if (part_of_multiple) | 
 |     uiout->field_skip ("type"); | 
 |   else | 
 |     uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type)); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* 3 */ | 
 |   annotate_field (2); | 
 |   if (part_of_multiple) | 
 |     uiout->field_skip ("disp"); | 
 |   else | 
 |     uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition)); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* 4 */ | 
 |   annotate_field (3); | 
 |   if (part_of_multiple) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* For locations that are disabled because of an invalid | 
 | 	 condition, display "N*" on the CLI, where "*" refers to a | 
 | 	 footnote below the table.  For MI, simply display a "N" | 
 | 	 without a footnote.  On the CLI, for enabled locations whose | 
 | 	 breakpoint is disabled, display "y-".  */ | 
 |       auto get_enable_state = [uiout, loc] () -> const char * | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      if (loc->disabled_by_cond) | 
 | 		return "N"; | 
 | 	      else if (!loc->enabled) | 
 | 		return "n"; | 
 | 	      else | 
 | 		return "y"; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      if (loc->disabled_by_cond) | 
 | 		return "N*"; | 
 | 	      else if (!loc->enabled) | 
 | 		return "n"; | 
 | 	      else if (!breakpoint_enabled (loc->owner)) | 
 | 		return "y-"; | 
 | 	      else | 
 | 		return "y"; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	}; | 
 |       uiout->field_string ("enabled", get_enable_state ()); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* 5 and 6 */ | 
 |   bool result = false; | 
 |   if (!raw_loc && b->print_one (last_loc)) | 
 |     result = true; | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (is_watchpoint (b)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  watchpoint *w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (b); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns | 
 | 	     not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect | 
 | 	     is relatively readable).  */ | 
 | 	  if (opts.addressprint) | 
 | 	    uiout->field_skip ("addr"); | 
 | 	  annotate_field (5); | 
 | 	  uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string.get ()); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else if (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b) | 
 | 	       || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (opts.addressprint) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      annotate_field (4); | 
 | 	      if (header_of_multiple) | 
 | 		uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>", | 
 | 				     metadata_style.style ()); | 
 | 	      else if (!b->has_locations () || loc->shlib_disabled) | 
 | 		uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>", | 
 | 				     metadata_style.style ()); | 
 | 	      else | 
 | 		uiout->field_core_addr ("addr", | 
 | 					loc->gdbarch, loc->address); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  annotate_field (5); | 
 | 	  if (!header_of_multiple) | 
 | 	    print_breakpoint_location (b, loc); | 
 | 	  if (b->has_locations ()) | 
 | 	    *last_loc = &b->first_loc (); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (loc != nullptr && !header_of_multiple && !loc->shlib_disabled) | 
 |     { | 
 |       std::vector<int> inf_nums; | 
 |       int mi_only = 1; | 
 |  | 
 |       for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace) | 
 | 	    inf_nums.push_back (inf->num); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless | 
 | 	 there are several.  Always display for MI. */ | 
 |       if (allflag | 
 | 	  || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (current_inferior ()->arch ()) | 
 | 	      && (program_spaces.size () > 1 | 
 | 		  || number_of_inferiors () > 1) | 
 | 	      /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in | 
 | 		 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER.  */ | 
 | 	      && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)) | 
 | 	mi_only = 0; | 
 |       output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_nums, mi_only); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* In the MI output, each location of a thread or task specific | 
 |      breakpoint includes the relevant thread or task ID.  This is done for | 
 |      backwards compatibility reasons. | 
 |  | 
 |      For the CLI output, the thread/task information is printed on a | 
 |      separate line, see the 'stop only in thread' and 'stop only in task' | 
 |      output below.  */ | 
 |   if (part_of_multiple && uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (b->thread != -1) | 
 | 	uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread); | 
 |       else if (b->task != -1) | 
 | 	uiout->field_signed ("task", b->task); | 
 |       else if (b->inferior != -1) | 
 | 	uiout->field_signed ("inferior", b->inferior); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!part_of_multiple) | 
 |     b->print_one_detail (uiout); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       annotate_field (6); | 
 |       uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at "); | 
 |       /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside | 
 | 	 the frame ID.  */ | 
 |       uiout->field_core_addr ("frame", | 
 | 			      b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr); | 
 |       uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 |     } | 
 |    | 
 |   if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string) | 
 |     { | 
 |       annotate_field (7); | 
 |       if (is_tracepoint (b)) | 
 | 	uiout->text ("\ttrace only if "); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	uiout->text ("\tstop only if "); | 
 |       uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string.get ()); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition | 
 | 	 evaluation.  If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything.  */ | 
 |       if (is_breakpoint (b) | 
 | 	  && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () | 
 | 	  == condition_evaluation_target) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  uiout->message (" (%pF evals)", | 
 | 			  string_field ("evaluated-by", | 
 | 					bp_condition_evaluator (b))); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* FIXME should make an annotation for this.  */ | 
 |       uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread "); | 
 |       if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 | 	uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr)); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!part_of_multiple && b->task != -1) | 
 |     { | 
 |       uiout->text ("\tstop only in task "); | 
 |       uiout->field_signed ("task", b->task); | 
 |       uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!part_of_multiple && b->inferior != -1) | 
 |     { | 
 |       uiout->text ("\tstop only in inferior "); | 
 |       uiout->field_signed ("inferior", b->inferior); | 
 |       uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!part_of_multiple) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (b->hit_count) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* FIXME should make an annotation for this.  */ | 
 | 	  if (is_catchpoint (b)) | 
 | 	    uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint"); | 
 | 	  else if (is_tracepoint (b)) | 
 | 	    uiout->text ("\ttracepoint"); | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint"); | 
 | 	  uiout->text (" already hit "); | 
 | 	  uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count); | 
 | 	  if (b->hit_count == 1) | 
 | 	    uiout->text (" time\n"); | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    uiout->text (" times\n"); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi.  */ | 
 | 	  if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 | 	    uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count) | 
 |     { | 
 |       annotate_field (8); | 
 |       uiout->message ("\tignore next %pF hits\n", | 
 | 		      signed_field ("ignore", b->ignore_count)); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once" | 
 |      behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and | 
 |      disposition, so we don't need to mention it here.  */ | 
 |   if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1) | 
 |     { | 
 |       annotate_field (8); | 
 |       uiout->text ("\tdisable after "); | 
 |       /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts | 
 | 	 are distinct, and have additive effect.  */ | 
 |       if (b->ignore_count) | 
 | 	uiout->text ("additional "); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	uiout->text ("next "); | 
 |       uiout->field_signed ("enable", b->enable_count); | 
 |       uiout->text (" hits\n"); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       tracepoint *tp = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (b); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (tp->traceframe_usage) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage "); | 
 | 	  uiout->field_signed ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage); | 
 | 	  uiout->text (" bytes\n"); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   l = b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL; | 
 |   if (!part_of_multiple && l) | 
 |     { | 
 |       annotate_field (9); | 
 |  | 
 |       bool use_fixed_output = | 
 | 	(uiout->test_flags (fix_breakpoint_script_output) | 
 | 	 || fix_breakpoint_script_output_globally); | 
 |  | 
 |       std::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter; | 
 |       std::optional<ui_out_emit_list> list_emitter; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (use_fixed_output) | 
 | 	list_emitter.emplace (uiout, "script"); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "script"); | 
 |  | 
 |       print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (is_tracepoint (b)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       tracepoint *t = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (b); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  annotate_field (10); | 
 | 	  uiout->text ("\tpass count "); | 
 | 	  uiout->field_signed ("pass", t->pass_count); | 
 | 	  uiout->text (" \n"); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is | 
 | 	 pending.   */ | 
 |       if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  annotate_field (11); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 | 	    uiout->field_string ("installed", | 
 | 				 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n"); | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      if (loc->inserted) | 
 | 		uiout->text ("\t"); | 
 | 	      else | 
 | 		uiout->text ("\tnot "); | 
 | 	      uiout->text ("installed on target\n"); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (is_watchpoint (b)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  watchpoint *w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (b); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string.get ()); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else if (b->locspec != nullptr) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  const char *str = b->locspec->to_string (); | 
 | 	  if (str != nullptr) | 
 | 	    uiout->field_string ("original-location", str); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return result; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | 
 |  | 
 | bool fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally = false; | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | print_one_breakpoint (breakpoint *b, const bp_location **last_loc, int allflag) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |   bool use_fixed_output | 
 |     = (uiout->test_flags (fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output) | 
 |        || fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally); | 
 |  | 
 |   std::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> bkpt_tuple_emitter (std::in_place, uiout, | 
 | 						       "bkpt"); | 
 |   bool printed = print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, | 
 | 						allflag, false); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* The mi2 broken format: the main breakpoint tuple ends here, the locations | 
 |      are outside.  */ | 
 |   if (!use_fixed_output) | 
 |     bkpt_tuple_emitter.reset (); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If this breakpoint has custom print function, | 
 |      it's already printed.  Otherwise, print individual | 
 |      locations, if any.  */ | 
 |   if (!printed || allflag) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we | 
 | 	 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's | 
 | 	 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled" | 
 | 	 situation. | 
 |  | 
 | 	 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations | 
 | 	 internally, that's not a property exposed to users. | 
 |  | 
 | 	 Likewise, while catchpoints may be implemented with | 
 | 	 breakpoints (e.g., catch throw), that's not a property | 
 | 	 exposed to users.  We do however display the internal | 
 | 	 breakpoint locations with "maint info breakpoints".  */ | 
 |       if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (b) | 
 | 	  && (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b) | 
 | 	      || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b)) | 
 | 	  && (allflag | 
 | 	      || (b->has_locations () | 
 | 		  && (b->has_multiple_locations () | 
 | 		      || !b->first_loc ().enabled | 
 | 		      || b->first_loc ().disabled_by_cond)))) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  std::optional<ui_out_emit_list> locations_list; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* For MI version <= 2, keep the behavior where GDB outputs an invalid | 
 | 	     MI record.  For later versions, place breakpoint locations in a | 
 | 	     list.  */ | 
 | 	  if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && use_fixed_output) | 
 | 	    locations_list.emplace (uiout, "locations"); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  int n = 1; | 
 | 	  for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      ui_out_emit_tuple loc_tuple_emitter (uiout, NULL); | 
 | 	      print_one_breakpoint_location (b, &loc, n, last_loc, | 
 | 					     allflag, allflag); | 
 | 	      n++; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static int | 
 | breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   int print_address_bits = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (!bl_address_is_meaningful (&loc)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       int addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc.gdbarch); | 
 |       if (addr_bit > print_address_bits) | 
 | 	print_address_bits = addr_bit; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return print_address_bits; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | print_breakpoint (breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   const bp_location *dummy_loc = nullptr; | 
 |   print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is | 
 |    internal or momentary.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | user_breakpoint_p (const breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   return b->number > 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | pending_breakpoint_p (const breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   return !b->has_locations (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Print information on breakpoints (including watchpoints and tracepoints). | 
 |  | 
 |    If non-NULL, BP_NUM_LIST is a list of numbers and number ranges as | 
 |    understood by number_or_range_parser.  Only breakpoints included in this | 
 |    list are then printed. | 
 |  | 
 |    If SHOW_INTERNAL is true, print internal breakpoints. | 
 |  | 
 |    If FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the | 
 |    ones for which it returns true. | 
 |  | 
 |    Return the total number of breakpoints listed.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static int | 
 | breakpoint_1 (const char *bp_num_list, bool show_internal, | 
 | 	      bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *)) | 
 | { | 
 |   const bp_location *last_loc = nullptr; | 
 |   int nr_printable_breakpoints; | 
 |   struct value_print_options opts; | 
 |   int print_address_bits = 0; | 
 |   int print_type_col_width = 14; | 
 |   struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |   bool has_disabled_by_cond_location = false; | 
 |  | 
 |   get_user_print_options (&opts); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size | 
 |      required for address fields.  */ | 
 |   nr_printable_breakpoints = 0; | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts.  */ | 
 |       if (filter && !filter (&b)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to | 
 | 	 accept.  Skip the others.  */ | 
 |       if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0') | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (show_internal && parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b.number) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 | 	  if (!show_internal && !number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b.number)) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  int addr_bit, type_len; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (&b); | 
 | 	  if (addr_bit > print_address_bits) | 
 | 	    print_address_bits = addr_bit; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b.type)); | 
 | 	  if (type_len > print_type_col_width) | 
 | 	    print_type_col_width = type_len; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  nr_printable_breakpoints++; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   { | 
 |     ui_out_emit_table table_emitter (uiout, | 
 | 				     opts.addressprint ? 6 : 5, | 
 | 				     nr_printable_breakpoints, | 
 | 				     "BreakpointTable"); | 
 |  | 
 |     if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
 |       annotate_breakpoints_headers (); | 
 |     if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
 |       annotate_field (0); | 
 |     uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */ | 
 |     if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
 |       annotate_field (1); | 
 |     uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */ | 
 |     if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
 |       annotate_field (2); | 
 |     uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */ | 
 |     if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
 |       annotate_field (3); | 
 |     uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */ | 
 |     if (opts.addressprint) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
 | 	  annotate_field (4); | 
 | 	if (print_address_bits <= 32) | 
 | 	  uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */ | 
 | 	else | 
 | 	  uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */ | 
 |       } | 
 |     if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
 |       annotate_field (5); | 
 |     uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */ | 
 |     uiout->table_body (); | 
 |     if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
 |       annotate_breakpoints_table (); | 
 |  | 
 |     for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	QUIT; | 
 | 	/* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts.  */ | 
 | 	if (filter && !filter (&b)) | 
 | 	  continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 	/* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to | 
 | 	   accept.  Skip the others.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0') | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    if (show_internal)	/* maintenance info breakpoint */ | 
 | 	      { | 
 | 		if (parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b.number) | 
 | 		  continue; | 
 | 	      } | 
 | 	    else		/* all others */ | 
 | 	      { | 
 | 		if (!number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b.number)) | 
 | 		  continue; | 
 | 	      } | 
 | 	  } | 
 | 	/* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the | 
 | 	   show_internal is set.  */ | 
 | 	if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    print_one_breakpoint (&b, &last_loc, show_internal); | 
 | 	    for (bp_location &loc : b.locations ()) | 
 | 	      if (loc.disabled_by_cond) | 
 | 		has_disabled_by_cond_location = true; | 
 | 	  } | 
 |       } | 
 |   } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report | 
 | 	 empty list.  */ | 
 |       if (!filter) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (bp_num_list == NULL || *bp_num_list == '\0') | 
 | 	    uiout->message ("No breakpoints, watchpoints, tracepoints, " | 
 | 			    "or catchpoints.\n"); | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    uiout->message ("No breakpoint, watchpoint, tracepoint, " | 
 | 			    "or catchpoint matching '%s'.\n", bp_num_list); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (last_loc && !server_command) | 
 | 	set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (has_disabled_by_cond_location && !uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 | 	uiout->message (_("(*): Breakpoint condition is invalid at this " | 
 | 			  "location.\n")); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* FIXME?  Should this be moved up so that it is only called when | 
 |      there have been breakpoints? */ | 
 |   annotate_breakpoints_table_end (); | 
 |  | 
 |   return nr_printable_breakpoints; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally | 
 |    compatible with the breakpoint list.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | default_collect_info (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a | 
 |      message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's | 
 |      not wanted.  */ | 
 |   if (default_collect.empty ()) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect | 
 |      actions.  */ | 
 |   uiout->text ("default collect "); | 
 |   uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect); | 
 |   uiout->text (" \n"); | 
 | } | 
 |    | 
 | static void | 
 | info_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   breakpoint_1 (args, false, NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   default_collect_info (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | info_watchpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_watchpoint); | 
 |   struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (num_printed == 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (args == NULL || *args == '\0') | 
 | 	uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n"); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   breakpoint_1 (args, true, NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   default_collect_info (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b, | 
 | 		   struct program_space *pspace, | 
 | 		   CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (bp_location &bl : b->locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (bl.pspace == pspace | 
 | 	  && bl.address == pc | 
 | 	  && (!overlay_debugging || bl.section == section)) | 
 | 	return true; | 
 |     } | 
 |   return false; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
 | 			    struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc, | 
 | 			    struct obj_section *section, int thread) | 
 | { | 
 |   int others = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     others += (user_breakpoint_p (&b) | 
 | 	       && breakpoint_has_pc (&b, pspace, pc, section)); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (others > 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (others == 1) | 
 | 	gdb_printf (_("Note: breakpoint ")); | 
 |       else /* if (others == ???) */ | 
 | 	gdb_printf (_("Note: breakpoints ")); | 
 |       for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 | 	if (user_breakpoint_p (&b) | 
 | 	    && breakpoint_has_pc (&b, pspace, pc, section)) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    others--; | 
 | 	    gdb_printf ("%d", b.number); | 
 | 	    if (b.thread == -1 && thread != -1) | 
 | 	      gdb_printf (" (all threads)"); | 
 | 	    else if (b.thread != -1) | 
 | 	      { | 
 | 		struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b.thread); | 
 | 		gdb_printf (" (thread %s)", print_thread_id (thr)); | 
 | 	      } | 
 | 	    else if (b.task != -1) | 
 | 	      gdb_printf (" (task %d)", b.task); | 
 | 	    gdb_printf ("%s%s ", | 
 | 			((b.enable_state == bp_disabled | 
 | 			  || b.enable_state == bp_call_disabled) | 
 | 			 ? " (disabled)" | 
 | 			 : ""), | 
 | 			(others > 1) ? ","  | 
 | 			: ((others == 1) ? " and" : "")); | 
 | 	  } | 
 |       current_uiout->message (_("also set at pc %ps.\n"), | 
 | 			      styled_string (address_style.style (), | 
 | 					     paddress (gdbarch, pc))); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of LOC. | 
 |    For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members are | 
 |    irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to | 
 |    other addresses (or use them for any other purpose either). | 
 |  | 
 |    More specifically, software watchpoints and catchpoints that are | 
 |    not backed by breakpoints always have a zero valued location | 
 |    address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of these types | 
 |    to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint location at address | 
 |    zero.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | bl_address_is_meaningful (const bp_location *loc) | 
 | { | 
 |   return loc->loc_type != bp_loc_other; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns | 
 |    true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | watchpoint_locations_match (const struct bp_location *loc1, | 
 | 			    const struct bp_location *loc2) | 
 | { | 
 |   watchpoint *w1 = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (loc1->owner); | 
 |   watchpoint *w2 = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (loc2->owner); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Both of them must exist.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (w1 != NULL); | 
 |   gdb_assert (w2 != NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware, | 
 |      then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at | 
 |      the same place.  Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when | 
 |      the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to | 
 |      true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the | 
 |      other watchpoint.  */ | 
 |   if ((w1->cond_exp | 
 |        && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,  | 
 | 						 loc1->length, | 
 | 						 loc1->watchpoint_type, | 
 | 						 w1->cond_exp.get ())) | 
 |       || (w2->cond_exp | 
 | 	  && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,  | 
 | 						    loc2->length, | 
 | 						    loc2->watchpoint_type, | 
 | 						    w2->cond_exp.get ()))) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's.  In | 
 |      case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does | 
 |      support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint | 
 |      watchpoints with hw_access locations.  Those should be considered | 
 |      duplicates of hw_read locations.  The hw_read locations will | 
 |      become hw_access locations later.  */ | 
 |   return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type | 
 | 	  && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace | 
 | 	  && loc1->address == loc2->address | 
 | 	  && loc1->length == loc2->length); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | breakpoint_address_match (const address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1, | 
 | 			  const address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2) | 
 | { | 
 |   return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (current_inferior ()->arch ()) | 
 | 	   || aspace1 == aspace2) | 
 | 	  && addr1 == addr2); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by | 
 |    {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}.  In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1 | 
 |    matches ASPACE2.  On targets that have global breakpoints, the address | 
 |    space doesn't really matter.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space *aspace1, | 
 | 				CORE_ADDR addr1, | 
 | 				int len1, const address_space *aspace2, | 
 | 				CORE_ADDR addr2) | 
 | { | 
 |   return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (current_inferior ()->arch ()) | 
 | 	   || aspace1 == aspace2) | 
 | 	  && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL.  BL may be | 
 |    a ranged breakpoint.  In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE | 
 |    matches the breakpoint's address space.  On targets that have global | 
 |    breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 				   const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 				   CORE_ADDR addr) | 
 | { | 
 |   return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace.get (), bl->address, | 
 | 				    aspace, addr) | 
 | 	  || (bl->length | 
 | 	      && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace.get (), | 
 | 						 bl->address, bl->length, | 
 | 						 aspace, addr))); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps | 
 |    breakpoint BL.  BL may be a ranged breakpoint.  In most targets, a | 
 |    match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address | 
 |    space.  On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space | 
 |    doesn't really matter.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 					   const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 					   CORE_ADDR addr, int len) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (current_inferior ()->arch ()) | 
 |       || bl->pspace->aspace.get () == aspace) | 
 |     { | 
 |       int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len)) | 
 | 	return 1; | 
 |     } | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly. | 
 |    Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns | 
 |    true, otherwise returns false.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | tracepoint_locations_match (const struct bp_location *loc1, | 
 | 			    const struct bp_location *loc2) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner)) | 
 |     /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint | 
 |        locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as | 
 |        different locations.  */ | 
 |     return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner); | 
 |   else | 
 |     return false; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses | 
 |    (bl_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent | 
 |    the same location.  If SW_HW_BPS_MATCH is true, then software | 
 |    breakpoint locations and hardware breakpoint locations match, | 
 |    otherwise they don't.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | breakpoint_locations_match (const struct bp_location *loc1, | 
 | 			    const struct bp_location *loc2, | 
 | 			    bool sw_hw_bps_match) | 
 | { | 
 |   int hw_point1, hw_point2; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL); | 
 |   gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner); | 
 |   hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (hw_point1 != hw_point2) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |   else if (hw_point1) | 
 |     return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2); | 
 |   else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner)) | 
 |     return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2); | 
 |   else | 
 |     /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged | 
 |        breakpoints.  Keep this in sync with | 
 |        bp_location_ptr_is_less_than.  */ | 
 |     return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace.get (), | 
 | 				      loc1->address, | 
 | 				      loc2->pspace->aspace.get (), | 
 | 				      loc2->address) | 
 | 	    && (loc1->loc_type == loc2->loc_type || sw_hw_bps_match) | 
 | 	    && loc1->length == loc2->length); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr, | 
 | 			       int bnum, bool have_bnum) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom | 
 |      is 50 chars.  These must be at least that big for safety.  */ | 
 |   char astr1[64]; | 
 |   char astr2[64]; | 
 |  | 
 |   strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8)); | 
 |   strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8)); | 
 |   if (have_bnum) | 
 |     warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."), | 
 | 	     bnum, astr1, astr2); | 
 |   else | 
 |     warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural | 
 |    constraints on breakpoint placement.  Return the adjusted address. | 
 |    Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment.  For most | 
 |    targets, this function is simply the identity function.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static CORE_ADDR | 
 | adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
 | 			   CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype, | 
 | 			   struct program_space *pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_assert (pspace != nullptr); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bptype == bp_watchpoint | 
 |       || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint | 
 |       || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint | 
 |       || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint | 
 |       || bptype == bp_catchpoint) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not | 
 | 	 have their addresses modified.  */ | 
 |       return bpaddr; | 
 |     } | 
 |   else if (bptype == bp_single_step) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses | 
 | 	 modified.  If there's any architectural constrain that | 
 | 	 applies to this address, then it should have already been | 
 | 	 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the | 
 | 	 first place.  If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g., | 
 | 	 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break.  */ | 
 |       return bpaddr; | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr = bpaddr; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement | 
 | 	 of breakpoint instructions.  Obtain the adjusted address.  */ | 
 |       if (gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* Targets that implement this adjustment function will likely | 
 | 	     inspect either the symbol table, target memory at BPADDR, or | 
 | 	     even state registers, so ensure a suitable thread (and its | 
 | 	     associated program space) are currently selected.  */ | 
 | 	  scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | 
 | 	  switch_to_program_space_and_thread (pspace); | 
 | 	  adjusted_bpaddr | 
 | 	    = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       adjusted_bpaddr | 
 | 	= gdbarch_remove_non_address_bits_breakpoint (gdbarch, adjusted_bpaddr); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter | 
 | 	 a user's expectations.  Print a warning if an adjustment | 
 | 	 is required.  */ | 
 |       if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr) | 
 | 	breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, false); | 
 |  | 
 |       return adjusted_bpaddr; | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static bp_loc_type | 
 | bp_location_from_bp_type (bptype type) | 
 | { | 
 |   switch (type) | 
 |     { | 
 |     case bp_breakpoint: | 
 |     case bp_single_step: | 
 |     case bp_until: | 
 |     case bp_finish: | 
 |     case bp_longjmp: | 
 |     case bp_longjmp_resume: | 
 |     case bp_longjmp_call_dummy: | 
 |     case bp_exception: | 
 |     case bp_exception_resume: | 
 |     case bp_step_resume: | 
 |     case bp_hp_step_resume: | 
 |     case bp_watchpoint_scope: | 
 |     case bp_call_dummy: | 
 |     case bp_std_terminate: | 
 |     case bp_shlib_event: | 
 |     case bp_thread_event: | 
 |     case bp_overlay_event: | 
 |     case bp_jit_event: | 
 |     case bp_longjmp_master: | 
 |     case bp_std_terminate_master: | 
 |     case bp_exception_master: | 
 |     case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: | 
 |     case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return: | 
 |     case bp_dprintf: | 
 |       return bp_loc_software_breakpoint; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_hardware_breakpoint: | 
 |       return bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
 |     case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
 |     case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
 |       return bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_watchpoint: | 
 |       return bp_loc_software_watchpoint; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_tracepoint: | 
 |     case bp_fast_tracepoint: | 
 |     case bp_static_tracepoint: | 
 |     case bp_static_marker_tracepoint: | 
 |       return bp_loc_tracepoint; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_catchpoint: | 
 |       return bp_loc_other; | 
 |  | 
 |     default: | 
 |       internal_error (_("unknown breakpoint type")); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner, bp_loc_type type) | 
 | { | 
 |   this->owner = owner; | 
 |   this->cond_bytecode = NULL; | 
 |   this->shlib_disabled = 0; | 
 |   this->enabled = 1; | 
 |   this->disabled_by_cond = false; | 
 |  | 
 |   this->loc_type = type; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (this->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
 |       || this->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 |     mark_breakpoint_location_modified (this); | 
 |  | 
 |   incref (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner) | 
 |   : bp_location::bp_location (owner, | 
 | 			      bp_location_from_bp_type (owner->type)) | 
 | { | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | std::string | 
 | bp_location::to_string () const | 
 | { | 
 |   string_file stb; | 
 |   ui_out_redirect_pop redir (current_uiout, &stb); | 
 |   print_breakpoint_location (this->owner, this); | 
 |   return stb.release (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Decrement reference count.  If the reference count reaches 0, | 
 |    destroy the bp_location.  Sets *BLP to NULL.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp) | 
 | { | 
 |   bp_location_ref_policy::decref (*blp); | 
 |   *blp = NULL; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static breakpoint * | 
 | add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of | 
 |      breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   breakpoint_chain.push_back (*b.release ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   return &breakpoint_chain.back (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Initialize loc->function_name.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint | 
 |       || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint | 
 |       || is_tracepoint (loc->owner)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       const char *function_name; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (loc->msymbol != NULL | 
 | 	  && (loc->msymbol->type () == mst_text_gnu_ifunc | 
 | 	      || loc->msymbol->type () == mst_data_gnu_ifunc)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  function_name = loc->msymbol->linkage_name (); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (b->type == bp_breakpoint | 
 | 	      && b->has_single_location () | 
 | 	      && b->related_breakpoint == b) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not | 
 | 		 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations.  */ | 
 | 	      b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver; | 
 | 	      /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return | 
 | 		 breakpoint.  */ | 
 | 	      loc->related_address = loc->address; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &function_name, NULL, NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (function_name) | 
 | 	loc->function_name = make_unique_xstrdup (function_name); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL.  */ | 
 | struct gdbarch * | 
 | get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (sal.section) | 
 |     return sal.section->objfile->arch (); | 
 |   if (sal.symtab) | 
 |     return sal.symtab->compunit ()->objfile ()->arch (); | 
 |  | 
 |   return NULL; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint | 
 |    if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP.  FRAME is the frame which | 
 |    initiated the operation.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame) | 
 | { | 
 |   int thread = tp->global_num; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step, | 
 |      we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled | 
 |      longjmp "master" breakpoints.  Here, we simply create momentary | 
 |      clones of those and enable them for the requested thread.  */ | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 |     if (b.pspace == current_program_space | 
 | 	&& (b.type == bp_longjmp_master | 
 | 	    || b.type == bp_exception_master)) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	bptype type = b.type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception; | 
 | 	/* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again | 
 | 	   after their removal.  */ | 
 | 	momentary_breakpoint_from_master (&b, type, 1, thread); | 
 |       } | 
 |  | 
 |   tp->initiating_frame = frame; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD.  */ | 
 | void | 
 | delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 |     if (b.type == bp_longjmp || b.type == bp_exception) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	if (b.thread == thread) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    gdb_assert (b.inferior == -1); | 
 | 	    delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 | 	  } | 
 |       } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 |     if (b.type == bp_longjmp || b.type == bp_exception) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	if (b.thread == thread) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    gdb_assert (b.inferior == -1); | 
 | 	    b.disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; | 
 | 	  } | 
 |       } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for | 
 |    INFERIOR_PTID thread.  Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return | 
 |    pointer to any of them.  Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp | 
 |    breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | struct breakpoint * | 
 | set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   breakpoint *retval = nullptr; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (b.pspace == current_program_space && b.type == bp_longjmp_master) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	int thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num; | 
 | 	breakpoint *new_b | 
 | 	  = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (&b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy, | 
 | 					      1, thread); | 
 |  | 
 | 	/* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b); | 
 | 	if (retval == NULL) | 
 | 	  retval = new_b; | 
 | 	new_b->related_breakpoint = retval; | 
 | 	while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint) | 
 | 	  retval = retval->related_breakpoint; | 
 | 	retval->related_breakpoint = new_b; | 
 |       } | 
 |  | 
 |   return retval; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for | 
 |    TP.  Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame | 
 |    stack. | 
 |  | 
 |    If the unwind fails then there is not sufficient information to discard | 
 |    dummy frames.  In this case, elide the clean up and the dummy frames will | 
 |    be cleaned up next time this function is called from a location where | 
 |    unwinding is possible.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* We would need to delete breakpoints other than the current one while | 
 |      iterating, so all_breakpoints_safe is not sufficient to make that safe. | 
 |      Save all breakpoints to delete in that set and delete them at the end.  */ | 
 |   gdb::unordered_set<breakpoint *> to_delete; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (struct breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (b.type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b.thread == tp->global_num) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  gdb_assert (b.inferior == -1); | 
 | 	  struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b.related_breakpoint; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Find the bp_call_dummy breakpoint in the list of breakpoints | 
 | 	     chained off b->related_breakpoint.  */ | 
 | 	  while (dummy_b != &b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy) | 
 | 	    dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* If there was no bp_call_dummy breakpoint then there's nothing | 
 | 	     more to do.  Or, if the dummy frame associated with the | 
 | 	     bp_call_dummy is still on the stack then we need to leave this | 
 | 	     bp_call_dummy in place.  */ | 
 | 	  if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy | 
 | 	      || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* We didn't find the dummy frame on the stack, this could be | 
 | 	     because we have longjmp'd to a stack frame that is previous to | 
 | 	     the dummy frame, or it could be because the stack unwind is | 
 | 	     broken at some point between the longjmp frame and the dummy | 
 | 	     frame. | 
 |  | 
 | 	     Next we figure out why the stack unwind stopped.  If it looks | 
 | 	     like the unwind is complete then we assume the dummy frame has | 
 | 	     been jumped over, however, if the unwind stopped for an | 
 | 	     unexpected reason then we assume the stack unwind is currently | 
 | 	     broken, and that we will (eventually) return to the dummy | 
 | 	     frame. | 
 |  | 
 | 	     It might be tempting to consider using frame_id_inner here, but | 
 | 	     that is not safe.   There is no guarantee that the stack frames | 
 | 	     we are looking at here are even on the same stack as the | 
 | 	     original dummy frame, hence frame_id_inner can't be used.  See | 
 | 	     the comments on frame_id_inner for more details.  */ | 
 | 	  bool unwind_finished_unexpectedly = false; | 
 | 	  for (frame_info_ptr fi = get_current_frame (); fi != nullptr; ) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      frame_info_ptr prev = get_prev_frame (fi); | 
 | 	      if (prev == nullptr) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  /* FI is the last stack frame.  Why did this frame not | 
 | 		     unwind further?  */ | 
 | 		  auto stop_reason = get_frame_unwind_stop_reason (fi); | 
 | 		  if (stop_reason != UNWIND_NO_REASON | 
 | 		      && stop_reason != UNWIND_OUTERMOST) | 
 | 		    unwind_finished_unexpectedly = true; | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	      fi = prev; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  if (unwind_finished_unexpectedly) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  for (breakpoint *related_breakpoint = b.related_breakpoint; | 
 | 	       related_breakpoint != &b; | 
 | 	       related_breakpoint = related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint) | 
 | 	    to_delete.insert (b.related_breakpoint); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  to_delete.insert (&b); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint *b : to_delete) | 
 |     delete_breakpoint (b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | enable_overlay_breakpoints (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (b.type == bp_overlay_event) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	b.enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
 | 	update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
 | 	overlay_events_enabled = 1; | 
 |       } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | disable_overlay_breakpoints (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (b.type == bp_overlay_event) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	b.enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
 | 	update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
 | 	overlay_events_enabled = 0; | 
 |       } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate | 
 |    master breakpoint.  */ | 
 | void | 
 | set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 |     if (b.pspace == current_program_space | 
 | 	&& b.type == bp_std_terminate_master) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	momentary_breakpoint_from_master (&b, bp_std_terminate, 1, | 
 | 					  inferior_thread ()->global_num); | 
 |       } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints.  */ | 
 | void | 
 | delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 |     if (b.type == bp_std_terminate) | 
 |       delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | struct breakpoint * | 
 | create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct breakpoint *b; | 
 |  | 
 |   b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event); | 
 |  | 
 |   b->enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
 |   /* locspec has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me.  */ | 
 |   b->locspec = new_address_location_spec (b->first_loc ().address, NULL, 0); | 
 |  | 
 |   update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
 |  | 
 |   return b; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | struct lang_and_radix | 
 |   { | 
 |     enum language lang; | 
 |     int radix; | 
 |   }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | struct breakpoint * | 
 | create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) | 
 | { | 
 |   return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s).  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 |     if (b.type == bp_jit_event | 
 | 	&& b.first_loc ().pspace == current_program_space) | 
 |       delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 |     if (b.type == bp_shlib_event | 
 | 	&& b.first_loc ().pspace == current_program_space) | 
 |       delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 |     if (b.type == bp_shlib_event | 
 | 	&& b.first_loc ().pspace == current_program_space) | 
 |       b.disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint / | 
 |    create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint.  Allows specifying which | 
 |    INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static struct breakpoint * | 
 | create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address, | 
 | 				 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct breakpoint *b; | 
 |  | 
 |   b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event); | 
 |   update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode); | 
 |   return b; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | struct breakpoint * | 
 | create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) | 
 | { | 
 |   return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | struct breakpoint * | 
 | create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct breakpoint *b; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert | 
 |      locations.  */ | 
 |   b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT); | 
 |   if (!b->first_loc ().inserted) | 
 |     { | 
 |       delete_breakpoint (b); | 
 |       return NULL; | 
 |     } | 
 |   return b; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon | 
 |    notification of unloaded_shlib.  Only apply to enabled breakpoints, | 
 |    disabled ones can just stay disabled. | 
 |  | 
 |    When STILL_IN_USE is true, SOLIB hasn't really been unmapped from | 
 |    the inferior.  In this case, don't disable anything. | 
 |  | 
 |    When SILENT is false notify the user if any breakpoints are disabled, | 
 |    otherwise, still disable the breakpoints, but don't tell the user.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (program_space *pspace, const solib &solib, | 
 | 				       bool still_in_use, bool silent) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (still_in_use) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   bool disabled_shlib_breaks = false; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       bool bp_modified = false; | 
 |  | 
 |       for (bp_location &loc : b.locations ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (pspace != loc.pspace || loc.shlib_disabled) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (loc.loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | 
 | 	      && loc.loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
 | 	      && !is_tracepoint (&b)) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (!solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc.address)) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  loc.shlib_disabled = 1; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* At this point, we don't know whether the shared library | 
 | 	     was unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the | 
 | 	     inserted flag alone.  We'll handle failure to uninsert | 
 | 	     quietly, in case the library was indeed unmapped. | 
 |  | 
 | 	     The test gdb.base/nostdlib.exp when run on AArch64 | 
 | 	     GNU/Linux using glibc will cause the dynamic linker to be | 
 | 	     unloaded from the inferior, but the linker will never be | 
 | 	     unmapped.  Additionally, at the time the dynamic linker | 
 | 	     is unloaded the inferior will be stopped within the | 
 | 	     dynamic linker. | 
 |  | 
 | 	     If we clear the inserted flag here then GDB will fail to | 
 | 	     remove the internal breakpoints from the dynamic linker | 
 | 	     leading to unexpected SIGTRAPs.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	  bp_modified = true; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (!disabled_shlib_breaks && !silent && user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      target_terminal::ours_for_output (); | 
 | 	      warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints " | 
 | 			 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""), | 
 | 		       solib.name.c_str ()); | 
 | 	      disabled_shlib_breaks = true; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (bp_modified) | 
 | 	notify_breakpoint_modified (&b); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon | 
 |    notification of free_objfile.  Only apply to enabled breakpoints, | 
 |    disabled ones can just stay disabled.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually | 
 |      managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file. | 
 |      Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in | 
 |      response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules | 
 |      shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global | 
 |      location list update.  Shared libraries not loaded by the user | 
 |      aren't handled here -- they're already handled in | 
 |      disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's | 
 |      solib_unloaded observer.  We skip objfiles that are not | 
 |      OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the | 
 |      main objfile).  */ | 
 |   if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0 | 
 |       || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       bool bp_modified = false; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!is_breakpoint (&b) && !is_tracepoint (&b)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       for (bp_location &loc : b.locations ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc.address; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (loc.loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | 
 | 	      && loc.loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (loc.shlib_disabled != 0) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (objfile->pspace () != loc.pspace) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile)) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      loc.shlib_disabled = 1; | 
 | 	      /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was | 
 | 		 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the | 
 | 		 inserted flag alone.  We'll handle failure to | 
 | 		 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed | 
 | 		 unmapped.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	      mark_breakpoint_location_modified (&loc); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      bp_modified = true; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (bp_modified) | 
 | 	notify_breakpoint_modified (&b); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | breakpoint::breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch_, enum bptype bptype, | 
 | 			bool temp, const char *cond_string_) | 
 |   : type (bptype), | 
 |     disposition (temp ? disp_del : disp_donttouch), | 
 |     gdbarch (gdbarch_), | 
 |     language (current_language->la_language), | 
 |     input_radix (::input_radix), | 
 |     cond_string (cond_string_ != nullptr | 
 | 		 ? make_unique_xstrdup (cond_string_) | 
 | 		 : nullptr), | 
 |     related_breakpoint (this) | 
 | { | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | catchpoint::catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, bool temp, | 
 | 			const char *cond_string) | 
 |   : breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_catchpoint, temp, cond_string) | 
 | { | 
 |   add_dummy_location (this, current_program_space); | 
 |  | 
 |   pspace = current_program_space; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | catchpoint::re_set (program_space *filter_pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* All catchpoints are associated with a specific program_space.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (pspace != nullptr); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If only a single program space changed, and it's not the program space | 
 |      for which this catchpoint applies, then there's nothing to do.  */ | 
 |   if (filter_pspace != nullptr && filter_pspace != pspace) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Catchpoints have a single dummy location.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (locations ().size () == 1); | 
 |   bp_location &bl = m_locations.front (); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (cond_string == nullptr) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* It shouldn't be possible to have a parsed condition expression | 
 | 	 cached on this location if the catchpoint doesn't have a condition | 
 | 	 string set.  */ | 
 |       gdb_assert (bl.cond == nullptr); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Nothing to re-compute, and the catchpoint cannot change.  */ | 
 |       return; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   bool previous_disabled_by_cond = bl.disabled_by_cond; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Start by marking the location disabled and discarding the previously | 
 |      computed condition expression.  Now if we get an exception, even if | 
 |      it's a quit exception, we'll leave the location disabled and there | 
 |      will be no (possibly invalid) expression cached.  */ | 
 |   bl.disabled_by_cond = true; | 
 |   bl.cond = nullptr; | 
 |  | 
 |   const char *s = cond_string.get (); | 
 |   try | 
 |     { | 
 |       switch_to_program_space_and_thread (pspace); | 
 |  | 
 |       bl.cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, bl.address, block_for_pc (bl.address), | 
 | 			     nullptr); | 
 |       bl.disabled_by_cond = false; | 
 |     } | 
 |   catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Any exception thrown must be from either the parse_exp_1 or | 
 | 	 earlier in the try block.  As such the following two asserts | 
 | 	 should be true.  */ | 
 |       gdb_assert (bl.disabled_by_cond); | 
 |       gdb_assert (bl.cond == nullptr); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (previous_disabled_by_cond != bl.disabled_by_cond) | 
 |     notify_breakpoint_modified (this); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Notify interpreters and observers that breakpoint B was created.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | notify_breakpoint_created (breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   interps_notify_breakpoint_created (b); | 
 |   gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | breakpoint * | 
 | install_breakpoint (int internal, std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&arg, int update_gll) | 
 | { | 
 |   breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg)); | 
 |   set_breakpoint_number (internal, b); | 
 |   if (is_tracepoint (b)) | 
 |     set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count); | 
 |   if (!internal) | 
 |     mention (b); | 
 |  | 
 |   notify_breakpoint_created (b); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (update_gll) | 
 |     update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
 |  | 
 |   return b; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static int | 
 | hw_breakpoint_used_count (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   int i = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (b.type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (&b)) | 
 |       for (bp_location &bl : b.locations ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than | 
 | 	     one register.  */ | 
 | 	  i += b.resources_needed (&bl); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |   return i; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware | 
 |    watchpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static int | 
 | hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   int i = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!breakpoint_enabled (b)) | 
 |     return 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bp_location &bl : b->locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than | 
 | 	 one register.  */ | 
 |       i += b->resources_needed (&bl); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return i; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of | 
 |    type TYPE in the breakpoints list.  Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED | 
 |    the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other | 
 |    types _not_ TYPE.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static int | 
 | hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except, | 
 | 				 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used) | 
 | { | 
 |   int i = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   *other_type_used = 0; | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (&b == except) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |       if (!breakpoint_enabled (&b)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (b.type == type) | 
 | 	i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (&b); | 
 |       else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (&b)) | 
 | 	*other_type_used = 1; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return i; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (is_watchpoint (&b) && breakpoint_enabled (&b)) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	b.enable_state = bp_call_disabled; | 
 | 	update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
 |       } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (is_watchpoint (&b) && b.enable_state == bp_call_disabled) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	b.enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
 | 	update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
 |       } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   current_program_space->executing_startup = 1; | 
 |   update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   current_program_space->executing_startup = 0; | 
 |   breakpoint_re_set (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Allocate a new momentary breakpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | template<typename... Arg> | 
 | static momentary_breakpoint * | 
 | new_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, enum bptype type, | 
 | 			  Arg&&... args) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (type == bp_longjmp || type == bp_exception) | 
 |     return new longjmp_breakpoint (gdbarch, type, | 
 | 				   std::forward<Arg> (args)...); | 
 |   else | 
 |     return new momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, type, | 
 | 				     std::forward<Arg> (args)...); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by | 
 |    SAL.  If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that | 
 |    frame.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | breakpoint_up | 
 | set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal, | 
 | 			  struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or | 
 |      tail-called one.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id)); | 
 |  | 
 |   std::unique_ptr<momentary_breakpoint> b | 
 |     (new_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, type, sal.pspace, frame_id, | 
 | 			       inferior_thread ()->global_num)); | 
 |  | 
 |   b->add_location (sal); | 
 |  | 
 |   breakpoint_up bp (add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b))); | 
 |  | 
 |   update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
 |  | 
 |   return bp; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG. | 
 |    The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its | 
 |    breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static struct breakpoint * | 
 | momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig, | 
 | 				  enum bptype type, | 
 | 				  int loc_enabled, | 
 | 				  int thread) | 
 | { | 
 |   std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> copy | 
 |     (new_momentary_breakpoint (orig->gdbarch, type, orig->pspace, | 
 | 			       orig->frame_id, thread)); | 
 |   const bp_location &orig_loc = orig->first_loc (); | 
 |   bp_location *copy_loc = copy->allocate_location (); | 
 |   copy->add_location (*copy_loc); | 
 |   set_breakpoint_location_function (copy_loc); | 
 |  | 
 |   copy_loc->gdbarch = orig_loc.gdbarch; | 
 |   copy_loc->requested_address = orig_loc.requested_address; | 
 |   copy_loc->address = orig_loc.address; | 
 |   copy_loc->section = orig_loc.section; | 
 |   copy_loc->pspace = orig_loc.pspace; | 
 |   copy_loc->probe = orig_loc.probe; | 
 |   copy_loc->line_number = orig_loc.line_number; | 
 |   copy_loc->symtab = orig_loc.symtab; | 
 |   copy_loc->enabled = loc_enabled; | 
 |  | 
 |   breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (copy)); | 
 |   update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
 |   return b; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG.  Returns NULL if | 
 |    ORIG is NULL.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | struct breakpoint * | 
 | clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing.  */ | 
 |   if (orig == NULL) | 
 |     return NULL; | 
 |  | 
 |   return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, 0, | 
 | 					   orig->thread); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | breakpoint_up | 
 | set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc, | 
 | 				enum bptype type) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct symtab_and_line sal; | 
 |  | 
 |   sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0); | 
 |   sal.pc = pc; | 
 |   sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc); | 
 |   sal.explicit_pc = 1; | 
 |  | 
 |   return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 | /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | mention (const breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   b->print_mention (); | 
 |   current_uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 | static bool bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc); | 
 |  | 
 | /* Handle "set breakpoint auto-hw on". | 
 |  | 
 |    If the explicitly specified breakpoint type is not hardware | 
 |    breakpoint, check the memory map to see whether the breakpoint | 
 |    address is in read-only memory. | 
 |  | 
 |    - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory is read-only. | 
 |    We change the type of the location to hardware breakpoint. | 
 |  | 
 |    - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write.  This | 
 |    means we've previously made the location hardware one, but then the | 
 |    memory map changed, so we undo. | 
 | */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints | 
 |       && bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint | 
 |       && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
 | 	  || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use | 
 | 	 location types we've just set here, the only possible problem | 
 | 	 is that memory map has changed during running program, but | 
 | 	 it's not going to work anyway with current gdb.  */ | 
 |       mem_region *mr = lookup_mem_region (bl->address); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (mr != nullptr) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  enum bp_loc_type new_type; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW) | 
 | 	    new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint; | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (new_type != bl->loc_type) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      static bool said = false; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      bl->loc_type = new_type; | 
 | 	      if (!said) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  gdb_printf (_("Note: automatically using " | 
 | 				"hardware breakpoints for " | 
 | 				"read-only addresses.\n")); | 
 | 		  said = true; | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | bp_location * | 
 | code_breakpoint::add_location (const symtab_and_line &sal) | 
 | { | 
 |   CORE_ADDR adjusted_address; | 
 |   struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (loc_gdbarch == NULL) | 
 |     loc_gdbarch = gdbarch; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location. | 
 |      Once we call allocate_location(), that mostly uninitialized | 
 |      location will be placed on the location chain.  Adjustment of the | 
 |      breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do | 
 |      not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and | 
 |      location that's only been partially initialized.  */ | 
 |   adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch, | 
 | 						sal.pc, type, | 
 | 						sal.pspace); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS.  */ | 
 |   bp_location *new_loc = this->allocate_location (); | 
 |  | 
 |   new_loc->requested_address = sal.pc; | 
 |   new_loc->address = adjusted_address; | 
 |   new_loc->pspace = sal.pspace; | 
 |   new_loc->probe.prob = sal.prob; | 
 |   new_loc->probe.objfile = sal.objfile; | 
 |   gdb_assert (new_loc->pspace != NULL); | 
 |   new_loc->section = sal.section; | 
 |   new_loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch; | 
 |   new_loc->line_number = sal.line; | 
 |   new_loc->symtab = sal.symtab; | 
 |   new_loc->symbol = sal.symbol; | 
 |   new_loc->msymbol = sal.msymbol; | 
 |  | 
 |   breakpoint::add_location (*new_loc); | 
 |  | 
 |   set_breakpoint_location_function (new_loc); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the | 
 |      code, we don't mark the location as inserted.  Normally one would expect | 
 |      that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program, | 
 |      thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing | 
 |      the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a | 
 |      SIGTRAP.  E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the | 
 |      instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies | 
 |      with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state".  Letting the | 
 |      breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB | 
 |      breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed. | 
 |      (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint, | 
 |      it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint | 
 |      instruction.)  */ | 
 |   if (bp_loc_is_permanent (new_loc)) | 
 |     new_loc->permanent = 1; | 
 |  | 
 |   return new_loc; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return true if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint, | 
 |    return false otherwise.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_assert (loc != NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If we have a non-breakpoint-backed catchpoint or a software | 
 |      watchpoint, just return 0.  We should not attempt to read from | 
 |      the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types point to. | 
 |      gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read | 
 |      memory.  */ | 
 |   if (!bl_address_is_meaningful (loc)) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |  | 
 |   scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | 
 |   switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace); | 
 |   return gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current | 
 |    settings of the dprintf style options.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_assert (b->type == bp_dprintf); | 
 |   gdb_assert (b->extra_string != nullptr); | 
 |  | 
 |   const char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string.get (); | 
 |   gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> printf_line = nullptr; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Trying to create a dprintf breakpoint without a format and args | 
 |      string should be detected at creation time.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (dprintf_args != nullptr); | 
 |  | 
 |   dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't | 
 |      insist on it.  */ | 
 |   if (*dprintf_args == ',') | 
 |     ++dprintf_args; | 
 |   dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (*dprintf_args != '"') | 
 |     error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0) | 
 |     printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args); | 
 |   else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (dprintf_function.empty ()) | 
 | 	error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call")); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!dprintf_channel.empty ()) | 
 | 	printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)", | 
 | 				  dprintf_function.c_str (), | 
 | 				  dprintf_channel.c_str (), | 
 | 				  dprintf_args); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)", | 
 | 				  dprintf_function.c_str (), | 
 | 				  dprintf_args); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ()) | 
 | 	printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf")); | 
 | 	  printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     internal_error (_("Invalid dprintf style.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Manufacture a printf sequence.  */ | 
 |   struct command_line *printf_cmd_line | 
 |     = new struct command_line (simple_control, printf_line.release ()); | 
 |   breakpoint_set_commands (b, counted_command_line (printf_cmd_line, | 
 | 						    command_lines_deleter ())); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect | 
 |    current style settings.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | update_dprintf_commands (const char *args, int from_tty, | 
 | 			 struct cmd_list_element *c) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (b.type == bp_dprintf) | 
 | 	update_dprintf_command_list (&b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | code_breakpoint::code_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch_, | 
 | 				  enum bptype type_, | 
 | 				  gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals, | 
 | 				  location_spec_up &&locspec_, | 
 | 				  gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_, | 
 | 				  gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_, | 
 | 				  gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_, | 
 | 				  enum bpdisp disposition_, | 
 | 				  int thread_, int task_, int inferior_, | 
 | 				  int ignore_count_, | 
 | 				  int from_tty, | 
 | 				  int enabled_, unsigned flags, | 
 | 				  int display_canonical_) | 
 |   : breakpoint (gdbarch_, type_) | 
 | { | 
 |   int i; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 |     { | 
 |       int target_resources_ok; | 
 |  | 
 |       i = hw_breakpoint_used_count (); | 
 |       target_resources_ok = | 
 | 	target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint, | 
 | 					    i + 1, 0); | 
 |       if (target_resources_ok == 0) | 
 | 	error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target.")); | 
 |       else if (target_resources_ok < 0) | 
 | 	error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit.")); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_assert (!sals.empty ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* At most one of thread, task, or inferior can be set on any breakpoint.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (((thread == -1 ? 0 : 1) | 
 | 	       + (task == -1 ? 0 : 1) | 
 | 	       + (inferior == -1 ? 0 : 1)) <= 1); | 
 |  | 
 |   thread = thread_; | 
 |   task = task_; | 
 |   inferior = inferior_; | 
 |  | 
 |   cond_string = std::move (cond_string_); | 
 |   extra_string = std::move (extra_string_); | 
 |   ignore_count = ignore_count_; | 
 |   enable_state = enabled_ ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled; | 
 |   disposition = disposition_; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (type == bp_static_tracepoint | 
 |       || type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint) | 
 |     { | 
 |       auto *t = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (this); | 
 |       struct static_tracepoint_marker marker; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (strace_marker_p (this)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we wouldn't | 
 | 	     see a sal for it.  */ | 
 | 	  const char *p = &locspec_->to_string ()[3]; | 
 | 	  const char *endp; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  p = skip_spaces (p); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  endp = skip_to_space (p); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  t->static_trace_marker_id.assign (p, endp - p); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  gdb_printf (_("Probed static tracepoint marker \"%s\"\n"), | 
 | 		      t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sals[0].pc, &marker)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  t->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  gdb_printf (_("Probed static tracepoint marker \"%s\"\n"), | 
 | 		      t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	warning (_("Couldn't determine the static tracepoint marker to probe")); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   for (const auto &sal : sals) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (from_tty) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal); | 
 | 	  if (loc_gdbarch == nullptr) | 
 | 	    loc_gdbarch = gdbarch; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch, | 
 | 				      sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       bp_location *new_loc = add_location (sal); | 
 |       if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0) | 
 | 	new_loc->inserted = 1; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Do not set breakpoint locations conditions yet.  As locations | 
 | 	 are inserted, they get sorted based on their addresses.  Let | 
 | 	 the list stabilize to have reliable location numbers.  */ | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the | 
 |      command line, otherwise it's an error.  */ | 
 |   if (type == bp_dprintf) | 
 |     update_dprintf_command_list (this); | 
 |   else | 
 |     gdb_assert (extra_string == nullptr); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* The order of the locations is now stable.  Set the location | 
 |      condition using the location's number.  */ | 
 |   int loc_num = 1; | 
 |   for (bp_location &bl : locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (cond_string != nullptr) | 
 | 	set_breakpoint_location_condition (cond_string.get (), &bl, | 
 | 					   number, loc_num); | 
 |  | 
 |       ++loc_num; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   display_canonical = display_canonical_; | 
 |   if (locspec_ != nullptr) | 
 |     locspec = std::move (locspec_); | 
 |   else | 
 |     locspec = new_address_location_spec (this->first_loc ().address, NULL, 0); | 
 |   filter = std::move (filter_); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
 | 		       gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals, | 
 | 		       location_spec_up &&locspec, | 
 | 		       gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter, | 
 | 		       gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string, | 
 | 		       gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string, | 
 | 		       enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition, | 
 | 		       int thread, int task, int inferior, int ignore_count, | 
 | 		       int from_tty, | 
 | 		       int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags, | 
 | 		       int display_canonical) | 
 | { | 
 |   std::unique_ptr<code_breakpoint> b | 
 |     = new_breakpoint_from_type (gdbarch, | 
 | 				type, | 
 | 				sals, | 
 | 				std::move (locspec), | 
 | 				std::move (filter), | 
 | 				std::move (cond_string), | 
 | 				std::move (extra_string), | 
 | 				disposition, | 
 | 				thread, task, inferior, ignore_count, | 
 | 				from_tty, | 
 | 				enabled, flags, | 
 | 				display_canonical); | 
 |  | 
 |   install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table.  For each | 
 |    SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i] | 
 |    value.  COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be | 
 |    used for all breakpoints.  Essentially the only case where | 
 |    SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded | 
 |    function.  In that case, it's still not possible to specify | 
 |    separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so | 
 |    we take just a single condition string. | 
 |     | 
 |    NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup | 
 |    the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the | 
 |    array contents).  If the function fails (error() is called), the | 
 |    caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, | 
 |    COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
 | 			struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
 | 			gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string, | 
 | 			gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string, | 
 | 			enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition, | 
 | 			int thread, int task, int inferior, | 
 | 			int ignore_count, | 
 | 			int from_tty, | 
 | 			int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (canonical->pre_expanded) | 
 |     gdb_assert (canonical->lsals.size () == 1); | 
 |  | 
 |   for (const auto &lsal : canonical->lsals) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain | 
 | 	 'break', without arguments.  */ | 
 |       location_spec_up locspec | 
 | 	= (canonical->locspec != nullptr | 
 | 	   ? canonical->locspec->clone () | 
 | 	   : nullptr); | 
 |       gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_string | 
 | 	(lsal.canonical != NULL ? xstrdup (lsal.canonical) : NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |       create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal.sals, | 
 | 			     std::move (locspec), | 
 | 			     std::move (filter_string), | 
 | 			     std::move (cond_string), | 
 | 			     std::move (extra_string), | 
 | 			     type, disposition, | 
 | 			     thread, task, inferior, ignore_count, | 
 | 			     from_tty, enabled, internal, flags, | 
 | 			     canonical->special_display); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Parse LOCSPEC which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly | 
 |    followed by conditionals.  On return, SALS contains an array of SAL | 
 |    addresses found.  LOCSPEC points to the end of the SAL (for | 
 |    linespec locspecs). | 
 |  | 
 |    The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is | 
 |    the caller's responsibility to free them.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | parse_breakpoint_sals (location_spec *locspec, | 
 | 		       struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
 | 		       struct program_space *search_pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (locspec->type () == LINESPEC_LOCATION_SPEC) | 
 |     { | 
 |       const char *spec | 
 | 	= as_linespec_location_spec (locspec)->spec_string.get (); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (spec == NULL) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default | 
 | 	     breakpoint address.  */ | 
 | 	  if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values | 
 | 		 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. | 
 | 		 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0 | 
 | 		 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise. | 
 | 		 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back.  */ | 
 | 	      symtab_and_line sal = get_last_displayed_sal (); | 
 | 	      CORE_ADDR pc = sal.pc; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC" | 
 | 		 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address.  So | 
 | 		 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from | 
 | 		 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other | 
 | 		 instances with the same symtab and line.  */ | 
 | 	      sal.pc = pc; | 
 | 	      sal.explicit_pc = 1; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      struct linespec_sals lsal; | 
 | 	      lsal.sals = {sal}; | 
 | 	      lsal.canonical = NULL; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal)); | 
 | 	      return; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    error (_("No default breakpoint address now.")); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the | 
 |      current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default). | 
 |      This should produce the results we want almost all of the | 
 |      time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone. | 
 |  | 
 |      ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which | 
 |      may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['.  */ | 
 |   symtab_and_line cursal | 
 |     = get_current_source_symtab_and_line (current_program_space); | 
 |   if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       const char *spec = NULL; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (locspec->type () == LINESPEC_LOCATION_SPEC) | 
 | 	spec = as_linespec_location_spec (locspec)->spec_string.get (); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!cursal.symtab | 
 | 	  || (spec != NULL | 
 | 	      && strchr ("+-", spec[0]) != NULL | 
 | 	      && spec[1] != '[')) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  decode_line_full (locspec, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace, | 
 | 			    get_last_displayed_symtab (), | 
 | 			    get_last_displayed_line (), | 
 | 			    canonical, NULL, NULL); | 
 | 	  return; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   decode_line_full (locspec, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace, | 
 | 		    cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 | /* Convert each SAL into a real PC.  Verify that the PC can be | 
 |    inserted as a breakpoint.  If it can't throw an error.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals) | 
 | {     | 
 |   for (auto &sal : sals) | 
 |     resolve_sal_pc (&sal); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations.  For | 
 |    instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will | 
 |    likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can | 
 |    only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a | 
 |    multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of | 
 |    it, etc.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
 | 			    gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (const auto &sal : sals) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct gdbarch *sarch; | 
 |  | 
 |       sarch = get_sal_arch (sal); | 
 |       /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture | 
 | 	 associated with SAL.  */ | 
 |       if (sarch == NULL) | 
 | 	sarch = gdbarch; | 
 |       std::string msg; | 
 |       if (!gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal.pc, &msg)) | 
 | 	error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"), | 
 | 	       paddress (sarch, sal.pc), msg.c_str ()); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static std::vector<symtab_and_line> | 
 | decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p) | 
 | { | 
 |   const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3]; | 
 |   const char *endp; | 
 |  | 
 |   p = skip_spaces (p); | 
 |  | 
 |   endp = skip_to_space (p); | 
 |  | 
 |   std::string marker_str (p, endp - p); | 
 |  | 
 |   std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers | 
 |     = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str.c_str ()); | 
 |   if (markers.empty ()) | 
 |     error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"), | 
 | 	   marker_str.c_str ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals; | 
 |   sals.reserve (markers.size ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   for (const static_tracepoint_marker &marker : markers) | 
 |     { | 
 |       symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (marker.address, 0); | 
 |       sal.pc = marker.address; | 
 |       sals.push_back (sal); | 
 |    } | 
 |  | 
 |   *arg_p = endp; | 
 |   return sals; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Returns the breakpoint ops appropriate for use with with LOCATION_TYPE and | 
 |    according to IS_TRACEPOINT.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static const struct breakpoint_ops * | 
 | breakpoint_ops_for_location_spec_type (enum location_spec_type locspec_type, | 
 | 				       bool is_tracepoint) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (is_tracepoint) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (locspec_type == PROBE_LOCATION_SPEC) | 
 | 	return &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops; | 
 |       else | 
 | 	return &code_breakpoint_ops; | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (locspec_type == PROBE_LOCATION_SPEC) | 
 | 	return &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops; | 
 |       else | 
 | 	return &code_breakpoint_ops; | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return the program space to use as a filter when searching for locations | 
 |    of a breakpoint specific to THREAD or INFERIOR.  If THREAD and INFERIOR | 
 |    are both -1, meaning all threads/inferiors, then this function returns | 
 |    nullptr, indicating no program space filtering should be performed. | 
 |    Otherwise, this function returns the program space for the inferior that | 
 |    contains THREAD (when THREAD is not -1), or the program space for | 
 |    INFERIOR (when INFERIOR is not -1).  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static struct program_space * | 
 | find_program_space_for_breakpoint (int thread, int inferior) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (thread != -1) | 
 |     { | 
 |       gdb_assert (inferior == -1); | 
 |  | 
 |       struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (thread); | 
 |       gdb_assert (thr != nullptr); | 
 |       gdb_assert (thr->inf != nullptr); | 
 |       return thr->inf->pspace; | 
 |     } | 
 |   else if (inferior != -1) | 
 |     { | 
 |       gdb_assert (thread == -1); | 
 |  | 
 |       struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_id (inferior); | 
 |       gdb_assert (inf != nullptr); | 
 |  | 
 |       return inf->pspace; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return nullptr; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | const struct breakpoint_ops * | 
 | breakpoint_ops_for_location_spec (const location_spec *locspec, | 
 | 				  bool is_tracepoint) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (locspec != nullptr) | 
 |     return (breakpoint_ops_for_location_spec_type | 
 | 	    (locspec->type (), is_tracepoint)); | 
 |   return &code_breakpoint_ops; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
 | 		   location_spec *locspec, | 
 | 		   const char *cond_string, | 
 | 		   int thread, int inferior, | 
 | 		   const char *extra_string, | 
 | 		   bool force_condition, int parse_extra, | 
 | 		   int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted, | 
 | 		   int ignore_count, | 
 | 		   enum auto_boolean pending_break_support, | 
 | 		   const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, | 
 | 		   int from_tty, int enabled, int internal, | 
 | 		   unsigned flags) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct linespec_result canonical; | 
 |   bool pending = false; | 
 |   int task = -1; | 
 |   int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count; | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_assert (thread == -1 || thread > 0); | 
 |   gdb_assert (inferior == -1 || inferior > 0); | 
 |   gdb_assert (thread == -1 || inferior == -1); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If PARSE_EXTRA is true then the thread and inferior details will be | 
 |      parsed from the EXTRA_STRING, the THREAD and INFERIOR arguments | 
 |      should be -1.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (!parse_extra || thread == -1); | 
 |   gdb_assert (!parse_extra || inferior == -1); | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_assert (ops != NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL.  */ | 
 |   if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0') | 
 |     extra_string = NULL; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* A bp_dprintf must always have an accompanying EXTRA_STRING containing | 
 |      the dprintf format and arguments -- PARSE_EXTRA should always be false | 
 |      in this case. | 
 |  | 
 |      For all other breakpoint types, EXTRA_STRING should be nullptr unless | 
 |      PARSE_EXTRA is true.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert ((type_wanted == bp_dprintf) | 
 | 	      ? (extra_string != nullptr && !parse_extra) | 
 | 	      : (extra_string == nullptr || parse_extra)); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Will hold either copies of the similarly named function argument, or | 
 |      will hold a modified version of the function argument, depending on | 
 |      the value of PARSE_EXTRA.  */ | 
 |   gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_copy; | 
 |   gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_copy; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (parse_extra) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Parse EXTRA_STRING splitting the parts out.  */ | 
 |       create_breakpoint_parse_arg_string (extra_string, &cond_string_copy, | 
 | 					  &thread, &inferior, &task, | 
 | 					  &extra_string_copy, | 
 | 					  &force_condition); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* We could check that EXTRA_STRING_COPY is empty at this point -- it | 
 | 	 should be, as we only get here for things that are not bp_dprintf, | 
 | 	 however, we prefer to give the location spec parser a chance to | 
 | 	 run first, this means the user will get errors about invalid | 
 | 	 location spec instead of an error about garbage at the end of the | 
 | 	 command line. | 
 |  | 
 | 	 We still do the EXTRA_STRING_COPY is empty check, just later in | 
 | 	 this function.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |       gdb_assert (thread == -1 || thread > 0); | 
 |       gdb_assert (task == -1 || task > 0); | 
 |       gdb_assert (inferior == -1 || inferior > 0); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (cond_string != nullptr) | 
 | 	cond_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (cond_string)); | 
 |       if (extra_string != nullptr) | 
 | 	extra_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (extra_string)); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Clear these.  Updated values are now held in the *_copy locals.  */ | 
 |   cond_string = nullptr; | 
 |   extra_string = nullptr; | 
 |  | 
 |   try | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct program_space *search_pspace | 
 | 	= find_program_space_for_breakpoint (thread, inferior); | 
 |       ops->create_sals_from_location_spec (locspec, &canonical, | 
 | 					   search_pspace); | 
 |     } | 
 |   catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set | 
 | 	 value.  */ | 
 |       if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw | 
 | 	     error.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE) | 
 | 	    throw; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  exception_print (gdb_stderr, e); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user | 
 | 	     selects no, then simply return the error code.  */ | 
 | 	  if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO | 
 | 	      && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "), | 
 | 			  bptype_string (type_wanted))) | 
 | 	    return 0; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting | 
 | 	     a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending | 
 | 	     breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint | 
 | 	     is defaulted on behalf of the user.  */ | 
 | 	  pending = true; | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	throw; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Only bp_dprintf breakpoints should have anything in EXTRA_STRING_COPY | 
 |      by this point.  For all other breakpoints this indicates an error.  We | 
 |      could place this check earlier in the function, but we prefer to see | 
 |      errors from the location spec parser before we see this error message.  */ | 
 |   if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf && extra_string_copy.get () != nullptr) | 
 |     error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), extra_string_copy.get ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!pending && canonical.lsals.empty ()) | 
 |     return 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses | 
 |      are ok for the target.  */ | 
 |   if (!pending) | 
 |     { | 
 |       for (auto &lsal : canonical.lsals) | 
 | 	breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal.sals); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location.  */ | 
 |   if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint) | 
 |     { | 
 |       for (const auto &lsal : canonical.lsals) | 
 | 	check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, lsal.sals); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any | 
 |      breakpoints.  Allocate a separate condition expression for each | 
 |      breakpoint.  */ | 
 |   if (!pending) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Check the validity of the condition.  We should error out if the | 
 | 	 condition is invalid at all of the locations and if it is not | 
 | 	 forced.  In the PARSE_EXTRA case above, this check is done when | 
 | 	 parsing the EXTRA_STRING.  */ | 
 |       if (cond_string_copy.get () != nullptr && !force_condition) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  int num_failures = 0; | 
 | 	  const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0]; | 
 | 	  for (const auto &sal : lsal.sals) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      const char *cond = cond_string_copy.get (); | 
 | 	      try | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  parse_exp_1 (&cond, sal.pc, block_for_pc (sal.pc), 0); | 
 | 		  /* One success is sufficient to keep going.  */ | 
 | 		  break; | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	      catch (const gdb_exception_error &) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  num_failures++; | 
 | 		  /* If this is the last sal, error out.  */ | 
 | 		  if (num_failures == lsal.sals.size ()) | 
 | 		    throw; | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical, | 
 | 				   std::move (cond_string_copy), | 
 | 				   std::move (extra_string_copy), | 
 | 				   type_wanted, | 
 | 				   tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch, | 
 | 				   thread, task, inferior, ignore_count, | 
 | 				   from_tty, enabled, internal, flags); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       std::unique_ptr <breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (gdbarch, | 
 | 								 type_wanted); | 
 |       b->locspec = locspec->clone (); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Create a private copy of the condition string.  */ | 
 |       b->cond_string = std::move (cond_string_copy); | 
 |  | 
 |       b->thread = thread; | 
 |       b->task = task; | 
 |       b->inferior = inferior; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Create a private copy of any extra string.  */ | 
 |       b->extra_string = std::move (extra_string_copy); | 
 |  | 
 |       b->ignore_count = ignore_count; | 
 |       b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch; | 
 |       b->condition_not_parsed = 1; | 
 |       b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (b->type == bp_dprintf) | 
 | 	update_dprintf_command_list (b.get ()); | 
 |  | 
 |       install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (canonical.lsals.size () > 1) | 
 |     { | 
 |       warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the " | 
 | 		 "\"%ps\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."), | 
 | 	       styled_string (command_style.style (), "delete")); | 
 |       prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
 |  | 
 |   return 1; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Set a breakpoint. | 
 |    ARG is a string describing breakpoint address, | 
 |    condition, and thread. | 
 |    FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on, | 
 |    and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG | 
 |    and BP_TEMPFLAG.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | break_command_1 (const char *arg, int flag, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG; | 
 |   enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG | 
 | 			     ? bp_hardware_breakpoint | 
 | 			     : bp_breakpoint); | 
 |  | 
 |   location_spec_up locspec = string_to_location_spec (&arg, current_language); | 
 |   const struct breakpoint_ops *ops | 
 |     = breakpoint_ops_for_location_spec (locspec.get (), | 
 | 					false /* is_tracepoint */); | 
 |  | 
 |   create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | 
 | 		     locspec.get (), | 
 | 		     NULL, | 
 | 		     -1 /* thread */, -1 /* inferior */, | 
 | 		     arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */, | 
 | 		     tempflag, type_wanted, | 
 | 		     0 /* Ignore count */, | 
 | 		     pending_break_support, | 
 | 		     ops, | 
 | 		     from_tty, | 
 | 		     1 /* enabled */, | 
 | 		     0 /* internal */, | 
 | 		     0); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal) | 
 | { | 
 |   CORE_ADDR pc; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc)) | 
 | 	error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."), | 
 | 	       sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab)); | 
 |       sal->pc = pc; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line | 
 | 	 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary.  */ | 
 |       if (sal->explicit_line) | 
 | 	skip_prologue_sal (sal); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL) | 
 |     { | 
 |       const struct blockvector *bv; | 
 |       const struct block *b; | 
 |       struct symbol *sym; | 
 |  | 
 |       bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, | 
 | 				    sal->symtab->compunit ()); | 
 |       if (bv != NULL) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  sym = b->linkage_function (); | 
 | 	  if (sym != NULL) | 
 | 	    sal->section | 
 | 	      = sym->obj_section (sal->symtab->compunit ()->objfile ()); | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll | 
 | 		 just have to look harder. This case can be executed | 
 | 		 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can | 
 | 		 happen in assembly source).  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	      scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | 
 | 	      switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      bound_minimal_symbol msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc); | 
 | 	      if (msym.minsym) | 
 | 		sal->section = msym.obj_section (); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | tbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | hbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | thbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but | 
 |    with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command, | 
 |    built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command | 
 |    line.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | dprintf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   location_spec_up locspec = string_to_location_spec (&arg, current_language); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location; | 
 |      the next character must be ','.  */ | 
 |   if (arg == nullptr || arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0') | 
 |     error (_("Format string required")); | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Skip the comma.  */ | 
 |       ++arg; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | 
 | 		     locspec.get (), | 
 | 		     NULL, -1, -1, | 
 | 		     arg, false, 0 /* parse arg */, | 
 | 		     0, bp_dprintf, | 
 | 		     0 /* Ignore count */, | 
 | 		     pending_break_support, | 
 | 		     &code_breakpoint_ops, | 
 | 		     from_tty, | 
 | 		     1 /* enabled */, | 
 | 		     0 /* internal */, | 
 | 		     0); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | agent_printf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target")); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" method for ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | ranged_breakpoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 				   const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 				   CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
 | 				   const target_waitstatus &ws) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (ws.kind () != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED | 
 |       || ws.sig () != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) | 
 |     return 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace.get (), | 
 | 					 bl->address, bl->length, aspace, | 
 | 					 bp_addr); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "resources_needed" method for ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | ranged_breakpoint::resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   return target_ranged_break_num_registers (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "print_it" method for ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | enum print_stop_action | 
 | ranged_breakpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const | 
 | { | 
 |   struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_assert (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (this->has_single_location ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   annotate_breakpoint (number); | 
 |  | 
 |   maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (disposition == disp_del) | 
 |     uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint "); | 
 |   else | 
 |     uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint "); | 
 |   if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       uiout->field_string ("reason", | 
 | 		      async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT)); | 
 |       uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (disposition)); | 
 |     } | 
 |   print_num_locno (bs, uiout); | 
 |   uiout->text (", "); | 
 |  | 
 |   return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "print_one" method for ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bool | 
 | ranged_breakpoint::print_one (const bp_location **last_loc) const | 
 | { | 
 |   struct value_print_options opts; | 
 |   struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (this->has_single_location ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   get_user_print_options (&opts); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (opts.addressprint) | 
 |     /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later | 
 |        by ranged_breakpoint::print_one_detail.  */ | 
 |     uiout->field_skip ("addr"); | 
 |   annotate_field (5); | 
 |   print_breakpoint_location (this, &this->first_loc ()); | 
 |   *last_loc = &this->first_loc (); | 
 |  | 
 |   return true; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "print_one_detail" method for ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | ranged_breakpoint::print_one_detail (struct ui_out *uiout) const | 
 | { | 
 |   CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end; | 
 |   const bp_location &bl = this->first_loc (); | 
 |   string_file stb; | 
 |  | 
 |   address_start = bl.address; | 
 |   address_end = address_start + bl.length - 1; | 
 |  | 
 |   uiout->text ("\taddress range: "); | 
 |   stb.printf ("[%s, %s]", | 
 | 	      print_core_address (bl.gdbarch, address_start), | 
 | 	      print_core_address (bl.gdbarch, address_end)); | 
 |   uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb); | 
 |   uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "print_mention" method for ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | ranged_breakpoint::print_mention () const | 
 | { | 
 |   const bp_location &bl = this->first_loc (); | 
 |   struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_assert (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint); | 
 |  | 
 |   uiout->message (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."), | 
 | 		  number, paddress (bl.gdbarch, bl.address), | 
 | 		  paddress (bl.gdbarch, bl.address + bl.length - 1)); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "print_recreate" method for ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | ranged_breakpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_printf (fp, "break-range %s, %s", | 
 | 	      locspec->to_string (), | 
 | 	      locspec_range_end->to_string ()); | 
 |   print_recreate_thread (fp); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be | 
 |    placed, given the SAL of the end of the range.  This is so that if | 
 |    the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the | 
 |    last instruction of the given line.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static CORE_ADDR | 
 | find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal) | 
 | { | 
 |   CORE_ADDR end; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If the user provided a PC value, use it.  Otherwise, | 
 |      find the address of the end of the given location.  */ | 
 |   if (sal.explicit_pc) | 
 |     end = sal.pc; | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       int ret; | 
 |       CORE_ADDR start; | 
 |  | 
 |       ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end); | 
 |       if (!ret) | 
 | 	error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range.")); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line.  */ | 
 |       end--; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return end; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | break_range_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   const char *arg_start; | 
 |   struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end; | 
 |   int bp_count, can_use_bp, length; | 
 |   CORE_ADDR end; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
 |   if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0) | 
 |     error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count (); | 
 |   bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers (); | 
 |   can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint, | 
 | 						   bp_count, 0); | 
 |   if (can_use_bp < 0) | 
 |     error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   arg = skip_spaces (arg); | 
 |   if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0') | 
 |     error(_("No address range specified.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   arg_start = arg; | 
 |   location_spec_up start_locspec | 
 |     = string_to_location_spec (&arg, current_language); | 
 |   parse_breakpoint_sals (start_locspec.get (), &canonical_start, nullptr); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (arg[0] != ',') | 
 |     error (_("Too few arguments.")); | 
 |   else if (canonical_start.lsals.empty ()) | 
 |     error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   const linespec_sals &lsal_start = canonical_start.lsals[0]; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (canonical_start.lsals.size () > 1 | 
 |       || lsal_start.sals.size () != 1) | 
 |     error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   const symtab_and_line &sal_start = lsal_start.sals[0]; | 
 |   std::string addr_string_start (arg_start, arg - arg_start); | 
 |  | 
 |   arg++;	/* Skip the comma.  */ | 
 |   arg = skip_spaces (arg); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Parse the end location specification.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   arg_start = arg; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using | 
 |      parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start | 
 |      location spec's symtab and line as the default symtab and line | 
 |      for the end of the range.  This makes it possible to have ranges | 
 |      like "foo.c:27, +14", where +14 means 14 lines from the start | 
 |      location spec.  */ | 
 |   location_spec_up end_locspec | 
 |     = string_to_location_spec (&arg, current_language); | 
 |   decode_line_full (end_locspec.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL, | 
 | 		    sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line, | 
 | 		    &canonical_end, NULL, NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (canonical_end.lsals.empty ()) | 
 |     error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   const linespec_sals &lsal_end = canonical_end.lsals[0]; | 
 |   if (canonical_end.lsals.size () > 1 | 
 |       || lsal_end.sals.size () != 1) | 
 |     error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   const symtab_and_line &sal_end = lsal_end.sals[0]; | 
 |  | 
 |   end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end); | 
 |   if (sal_start.pc > end) | 
 |     error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   length = end - sal_start.pc + 1; | 
 |   if (length < 0) | 
 |     /* Length overflowed.  */ | 
 |     error (_("Address range too large.")); | 
 |   else if (length == 1) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* This range is simple enough to be handled by | 
 | 	 the `hbreak' command.  */ | 
 |       hbreak_command (&addr_string_start[0], 1); | 
 |  | 
 |       return; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Now set up the breakpoint and install it.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> br | 
 |     (new ranged_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | 
 | 			    sal_start, length, | 
 | 			    std::move (start_locspec), | 
 | 			    std::move (end_locspec))); | 
 |  | 
 |   install_breakpoint (false, std::move (br), true); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | watchpoint::~watchpoint () | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Make sure to unlink the destroyed watchpoint from the related | 
 |      breakpoint ring.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   breakpoint *bpt = this; | 
 |   while (bpt->related_breakpoint != this) | 
 |     bpt = bpt->related_breakpoint; | 
 |  | 
 |   bpt->related_breakpoint = this->related_breakpoint; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /*  Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant.  Returned zero | 
 |     means EXP is variable.  Also the constant detection may fail for | 
 |     some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return | 
 |     zero.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp) | 
 | { | 
 |   return exp->op->constant_p (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "re_set" method for watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | watchpoint::re_set (struct program_space *pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global | 
 |      variables, or it can be on local variables. | 
 |  | 
 |      Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even | 
 |      persist across program restarts.  Since they can use variables | 
 |      from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries | 
 |      are loaded and unloaded. | 
 |  | 
 |      Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result | 
 |      of solib event.  For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local | 
 |      and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint, | 
 |      but unloading of a shared library will make the expression | 
 |      invalid.  This is not a very common use case, but we still | 
 |      re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user. | 
 |  | 
 |      Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if | 
 |      watchpoints frame id is still valid.  If it's not, it means the | 
 |      watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon.  In fact, | 
 |      I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case. | 
 |  | 
 |      If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then | 
 |      exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it. | 
 |  | 
 |      Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be | 
 |      reevaluated again when enabled.  */ | 
 |   update_watchpoint (this, true /* reparse */); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "insert" method for hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | watchpoint::insert_location (struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   int length = exact ? 1 : bl->length; | 
 |  | 
 |   return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type, | 
 | 				   cond_exp.get ()); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "remove" method for hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | watchpoint::remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 			     enum remove_bp_reason reason) | 
 | { | 
 |   int length = exact ? 1 : bl->length; | 
 |  | 
 |   return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type, | 
 | 				   cond_exp.get ()); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | watchpoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 			    const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
 | 			    const target_waitstatus &ws) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the | 
 |      reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on | 
 |      some data address).  Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction | 
 |      in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has | 
 |      been defined.  Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger | 
 |      (did not match the data address).  */ | 
 |   if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b) | 
 |       && watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no) | 
 |     return 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   return 1; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | watchpoint::check_status (bpstat *bs) | 
 | { | 
 |   bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "resources_needed" method for hardware | 
 |    watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | watchpoint::resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   int length = exact? 1 : bl->length; | 
 |  | 
 |   return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" method for hardware | 
 |    watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bool | 
 | watchpoint::works_in_software_mode () const | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support.  */ | 
 |   return type == bp_watchpoint || type == bp_hardware_watchpoint; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | enum print_stop_action | 
 | watchpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const | 
 | { | 
 |   enum print_stop_action result; | 
 |   struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   annotate_watchpoint (this->number); | 
 |   maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | 
 |  | 
 |   string_file stb; | 
 |  | 
 |   std::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter; | 
 |   switch (this->type) | 
 |     { | 
 |     case bp_watchpoint: | 
 |     case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
 |       if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 | 	uiout->field_string | 
 | 	  ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | 
 |       mention (this); | 
 |       tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value"); | 
 |       uiout->text ("\nOld value = "); | 
 |       watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb); | 
 |       uiout->field_stream ("old", stb); | 
 |       uiout->text ("\nNew value = "); | 
 |       watchpoint_value_print (val.get (), &stb); | 
 |       uiout->field_stream ("new", stb); | 
 |       uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 |       /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered.  */ | 
 |       result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
 |       break; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
 |       if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 | 	uiout->field_string | 
 | 	  ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | 
 |       mention (this); | 
 |       tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value"); | 
 |       uiout->text ("\nValue = "); | 
 |       watchpoint_value_print (val.get (), &stb); | 
 |       uiout->field_stream ("value", stb); | 
 |       uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 |       result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
 |       break; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
 |       if (bs->old_val != NULL) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 | 	    uiout->field_string | 
 | 	      ("reason", | 
 | 	       async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | 
 | 	  mention (this); | 
 | 	  tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value"); | 
 | 	  uiout->text ("\nOld value = "); | 
 | 	  watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb); | 
 | 	  uiout->field_stream ("old", stb); | 
 | 	  uiout->text ("\nNew value = "); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  mention (this); | 
 | 	  if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 | 	    uiout->field_string | 
 | 	      ("reason", | 
 | 	       async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | 
 | 	  tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value"); | 
 | 	  uiout->text ("\nValue = "); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       watchpoint_value_print (val.get (), &stb); | 
 |       uiout->field_stream ("new", stb); | 
 |       uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 |       result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
 |       break; | 
 |     default: | 
 |       result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return result; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "print_mention" method for hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | watchpoint::print_mention () const | 
 | { | 
 |   struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |   const char *tuple_name; | 
 |  | 
 |   switch (type) | 
 |     { | 
 |     case bp_watchpoint: | 
 |       uiout->text ("Watchpoint "); | 
 |       tuple_name = "wpt"; | 
 |       break; | 
 |     case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
 |       uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint "); | 
 |       tuple_name = "wpt"; | 
 |       break; | 
 |     case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
 |       uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint "); | 
 |       tuple_name = "hw-rwpt"; | 
 |       break; | 
 |     case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
 |       uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint "); | 
 |       tuple_name = "hw-awpt"; | 
 |       break; | 
 |     default: | 
 |       internal_error (_("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name); | 
 |   uiout->field_signed ("number", number); | 
 |   uiout->text (": "); | 
 |   uiout->field_string ("exp", exp_string.get ()); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "print_recreate" method for watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | watchpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const | 
 | { | 
 |   switch (type) | 
 |     { | 
 |     case bp_watchpoint: | 
 |     case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
 |       gdb_printf (fp, "watch"); | 
 |       break; | 
 |     case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
 |       gdb_printf (fp, "rwatch"); | 
 |       break; | 
 |     case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
 |       gdb_printf (fp, "awatch"); | 
 |       break; | 
 |     default: | 
 |       internal_error (_("Invalid watchpoint type.")); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_printf (fp, " %s", exp_string.get ()); | 
 |   print_recreate_thread (fp); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "explains_signal" method for watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bool | 
 | watchpoint::explains_signal (enum gdb_signal sig) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than | 
 |      GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP.  */ | 
 |   if (type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) | 
 |     return false; | 
 |  | 
 |   return true; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | struct masked_watchpoint : public watchpoint | 
 | { | 
 |   using watchpoint::watchpoint; | 
 |  | 
 |   int insert_location (struct bp_location *) override; | 
 |   int remove_location (struct bp_location *, | 
 | 		       enum remove_bp_reason reason) override; | 
 |   int resources_needed (const struct bp_location *) override; | 
 |   bool works_in_software_mode () const override; | 
 |   enum print_stop_action print_it (const bpstat *bs) const override; | 
 |   void print_one_detail (struct ui_out *) const override; | 
 |   void print_mention () const override; | 
 |   void print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const override; | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "insert" method for masked hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | masked_watchpoint::insert_location (struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, hw_wp_mask, | 
 | 					bl->watchpoint_type); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "remove" method for masked hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | masked_watchpoint::remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 				    enum remove_bp_reason reason) | 
 | { | 
 |   return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, hw_wp_mask, | 
 | 					bl->watchpoint_type); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "resources_needed" method for masked hardware | 
 |    watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | masked_watchpoint::resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, hw_wp_mask); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" method for masked hardware | 
 |    watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bool | 
 | masked_watchpoint::works_in_software_mode () const | 
 | { | 
 |   return false; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "print_it" method for masked hardware | 
 |    watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | enum print_stop_action | 
 | masked_watchpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const | 
 | { | 
 |   struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Masked watchpoints have only one location.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (this->has_single_location ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   annotate_watchpoint (this->number); | 
 |   maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | 
 |  | 
 |   switch (this->type) | 
 |     { | 
 |     case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
 |       if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 | 	uiout->field_string | 
 | 	  ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | 
 |       break; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
 |       if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 | 	uiout->field_string | 
 | 	  ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | 
 |       break; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
 |       if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 | 	uiout->field_string | 
 | 	  ("reason", | 
 | 	   async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | 
 |       break; | 
 |     default: | 
 |       internal_error (_("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   mention (this); | 
 |   uiout->text (_("\n\ | 
 | Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\ | 
 | address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n")); | 
 |   uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered.  */ | 
 |   return PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "print_one_detail" method for masked hardware | 
 |    watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | masked_watchpoint::print_one_detail (struct ui_out *uiout) const | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Masked watchpoints have only one location.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (this->has_single_location ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   uiout->text ("\tmask "); | 
 |   uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", this->first_loc ().gdbarch, hw_wp_mask); | 
 |   uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "print_mention" method for masked hardware | 
 |    watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | masked_watchpoint::print_mention () const | 
 | { | 
 |   struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |   const char *tuple_name; | 
 |  | 
 |   switch (type) | 
 |     { | 
 |     case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
 |       uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint "); | 
 |       tuple_name = "wpt"; | 
 |       break; | 
 |     case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
 |       uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint "); | 
 |       tuple_name = "hw-rwpt"; | 
 |       break; | 
 |     case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
 |       uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint "); | 
 |       tuple_name = "hw-awpt"; | 
 |       break; | 
 |     default: | 
 |       internal_error (_("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name); | 
 |   uiout->field_signed ("number", number); | 
 |   uiout->text (": "); | 
 |   uiout->field_string ("exp", exp_string.get ()); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "print_recreate" method for masked hardware | 
 |    watchpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | masked_watchpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const | 
 | { | 
 |   switch (type) | 
 |     { | 
 |     case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
 |       gdb_printf (fp, "watch"); | 
 |       break; | 
 |     case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
 |       gdb_printf (fp, "rwatch"); | 
 |       break; | 
 |     case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
 |       gdb_printf (fp, "awatch"); | 
 |       break; | 
 |     default: | 
 |       internal_error (_("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_printf (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", exp_string.get (), | 
 | 	      phex (hw_wp_mask)); | 
 |   print_recreate_thread (fp); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   return dynamic_cast<const masked_watchpoint *> (b) != nullptr; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* accessflag:  hw_write:  watch write,  | 
 | 		hw_read:   watch read,  | 
 | 		hw_access: watch access (read or write) */ | 
 | static void | 
 | watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty, | 
 | 		 bool just_location, bool internal) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct breakpoint *scope_breakpoint = NULL; | 
 |   const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL; | 
 |   struct value *result; | 
 |   int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0; | 
 |   const char *exp_start = NULL; | 
 |   const char *exp_end = NULL; | 
 |   const char *tok, *end_tok; | 
 |   int toklen = -1; | 
 |   const char *cond_start = NULL; | 
 |   const char *cond_end = NULL; | 
 |   enum bptype bp_type; | 
 |   int thread = -1; | 
 |   int inferior = -1; | 
 |   /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for | 
 |      the hardware watchpoint.  */ | 
 |   bool use_mask = false; | 
 |   CORE_ADDR mask = 0; | 
 |   int task = -1; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse.  */ | 
 |   if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0') | 
 |     { | 
 |       const char *value_start; | 
 |  | 
 |       exp_end = arg + strlen (arg); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end | 
 | 	 of the arguments string.  */ | 
 |       for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list.  */ | 
 | 	  while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')) | 
 | 	    tok--; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Find the beginning of the last token. | 
 | 	     This is the value of the parameter.  */ | 
 | 	  while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t')) | 
 | 	    tok--; | 
 | 	  value_start = tok + 1; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Skip whitespace.  */ | 
 | 	  while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')) | 
 | 	    tok--; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  end_tok = tok; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Find the beginning of the second to last token. | 
 | 	     This is the parameter itself.  */ | 
 | 	  while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t')) | 
 | 	    tok--; | 
 | 	  tok++; | 
 | 	  toklen = end_tok - tok + 1; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread")) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      struct thread_info *thr; | 
 | 	      /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means | 
 | 		 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers | 
 | 		 only in a specific thread.  */ | 
 | 	      const char *endp; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      if (thread != -1) | 
 | 		error(_("You can specify only one thread.")); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      if (task != -1) | 
 | 		error (_("You can specify only one of thread or task.")); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      if (inferior != -1) | 
 | 		error (_("You can specify only one of inferior or thread.")); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      /* Extract the thread ID from the next token.  */ | 
 | 	      thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp); | 
 | 	      if (value_start == endp) | 
 | 		error (_("Junk after thread keyword.")); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      thread = thr->global_num; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "task")) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      char *tmp; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      if (task != -1) | 
 | 		error(_("You can specify only one task.")); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      if (thread != -1) | 
 | 		error (_("You can specify only one of thread or task.")); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      if (inferior != -1) | 
 | 		error (_("You can specify only one of inferior or task.")); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      task = strtol (value_start, &tmp, 0); | 
 | 	      if (tmp == value_start) | 
 | 		error (_("Junk after task keyword.")); | 
 | 	      if (!valid_task_id (task)) | 
 | 		error (_("Unknown task %d."), task); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else if (toklen == 8 && startswith (tok, "inferior")) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Support for watchpoints will be added in a later commit.  */ | 
 | 	      error (_("Cannot use 'inferior' keyword with watchpoints")); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask")) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to | 
 | 		 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask | 
 | 		 facility.  */ | 
 | 	      struct value *mask_value; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      if (use_mask) | 
 | 		error(_("You can specify only one mask.")); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      use_mask = just_location = true; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      scoped_value_mark mark; | 
 | 	      mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start); | 
 | 	      mask = value_as_address (mask_value); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    /* We didn't recognize what we found.  We should stop here.  */ | 
 | 	    break; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before | 
 | 	     the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function.  */ | 
 | 	  exp_end = tok; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     exp_end = arg; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Parse the rest of the arguments.  From here on out, everything | 
 |      is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original | 
 |      ARG.  */ | 
 |   std::string expression (arg, exp_end - arg); | 
 |   exp_start = arg = expression.c_str (); | 
 |   innermost_block_tracker tracker; | 
 |   expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker); | 
 |   exp_end = arg; | 
 |   /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it. | 
 |      This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit | 
 |      prettier.  */ | 
 |   while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t')) | 
 |     --exp_end; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Checking if the expression is not constant.  */ | 
 |   if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ())) | 
 |     { | 
 |       int len; | 
 |  | 
 |       len = exp_end - exp_start; | 
 |       while (len > 0 && c_isspace (exp_start[len - 1])) | 
 | 	len--; | 
 |       error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   exp_valid_block = tracker.block (); | 
 |   struct value *mark = value_mark (); | 
 |   struct value *val_as_value = nullptr; | 
 |   fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), exp->op.get (), &val_as_value, &result, NULL, | 
 | 		      just_location); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (val_as_value != NULL && just_location) | 
 |     { | 
 |       saved_bitpos = val_as_value->bitpos (); | 
 |       saved_bitsize = val_as_value->bitsize (); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   value_ref_ptr val; | 
 |   if (just_location) | 
 |     { | 
 |       int ret; | 
 |  | 
 |       exp_valid_block = NULL; | 
 |       val = release_value (value_addr (result)); | 
 |       value_free_to_mark (mark); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (use_mask) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val.get ()), | 
 | 						   mask); | 
 | 	  if (ret == -1) | 
 | 	    error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints.")); | 
 | 	  else if (ret == -2) | 
 | 	    error (_("Invalid mask or memory region.")); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |   else if (val_as_value != NULL) | 
 |     val = release_value (val_as_value); | 
 |  | 
 |   tok = skip_spaces (arg); | 
 |   end_tok = skip_to_space (tok); | 
 |  | 
 |   toklen = end_tok - tok; | 
 |   if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1; | 
 |       innermost_block_tracker if_tracker; | 
 |       parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0, &if_tracker); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition | 
 | 	 may still be.  E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'.  */ | 
 |       cond_exp_valid_block = if_tracker.block (); | 
 |  | 
 |       cond_end = tok; | 
 |     } | 
 |   if (*tok) | 
 |     error (_("Junk at end of command.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   frame_info_ptr wp_frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates | 
 |      'wp_frame'.  */ | 
 |   frame_id watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (wp_frame); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Now set up the breakpoint.  We create all watchpoints as hardware | 
 |      watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call | 
 |      to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to | 
 |      drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   if (accessflag == hw_read) | 
 |     bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint; | 
 |   else if (accessflag == hw_access) | 
 |     bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint; | 
 |   else | 
 |     bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint; | 
 |  | 
 |   std::unique_ptr<watchpoint> w; | 
 |   if (use_mask) | 
 |     w = std::make_unique<masked_watchpoint> (nullptr, bp_type); | 
 |   else | 
 |     w = std::make_unique<watchpoint> (nullptr, bp_type); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* At most one of thread or task can be set on a watchpoint.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (thread == -1 || task == -1); | 
 |   w->thread = thread; | 
 |   w->inferior = inferior; | 
 |   w->task = task; | 
 |   w->disposition = disp_donttouch; | 
 |   w->pspace = current_program_space; | 
 |   w->exp = std::move (exp); | 
 |   w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block; | 
 |   w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block; | 
 |   if (just_location) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct type *t = val->type (); | 
 |       CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val.get ()); | 
 |  | 
 |       w->exp_string_reparse | 
 | 	= current_language->watch_location_expression (t, addr); | 
 |  | 
 |       w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s", | 
 | 				  (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     w->exp_string.reset (savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start)); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (use_mask) | 
 |     { | 
 |       w->hw_wp_mask = mask; | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       w->val = val; | 
 |       w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos; | 
 |       w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize; | 
 |       w->val_valid = true; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (cond_start) | 
 |     w->cond_string.reset (savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start)); | 
 |   else | 
 |     w->cond_string = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       w->watchpoint_frame = watchpoint_frame; | 
 |       w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid; | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id; | 
 |       w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!just_location) | 
 |     value_free_to_mark (mark); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Finally update the new watchpoint.  This creates the locations | 
 |      that should be inserted.  */ | 
 |   update_watchpoint (w.get (), true /* reparse */); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope" | 
 |      breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint | 
 |      expression.  Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so | 
 |      that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status.  */ | 
 |   if (exp_valid_block != nullptr && wp_frame != nullptr) | 
 |     { | 
 |       frame_id caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  gdbarch *caller_arch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame); | 
 | 	  CORE_ADDR caller_pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  scope_breakpoint | 
 | 	    = create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch, caller_pc, | 
 | 					  bp_watchpoint_scope); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME.  */ | 
 | 	  wp_frame = nullptr; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits.  */ | 
 | 	  scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion).  */ | 
 | 	  scope_breakpoint->frame_id = caller_frame_id; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Set the address at which we will stop.  */ | 
 | 	  bp_location &loc = scope_breakpoint->first_loc (); | 
 | 	  loc.gdbarch = caller_arch; | 
 | 	  loc.requested_address = caller_pc; | 
 | 	  loc.address | 
 | 	    = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc.gdbarch, loc.requested_address, | 
 | 					 scope_breakpoint->type, | 
 | 					 current_program_space); | 
 | 	} | 
 |   } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (scope_breakpoint != nullptr) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint.  We will | 
 | 	 need to act on them together.  */ | 
 |       w->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint; | 
 |       scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w.get (); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Verify that the scope breakpoint comes before the watchpoint in the | 
 |      breakpoint chain.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (scope_breakpoint == nullptr | 
 | 	      || &breakpoint_chain.back () == scope_breakpoint); | 
 |   watchpoint *watchpoint_ptr = w.get (); | 
 |   install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (w), 1); | 
 |   gdb_assert (&breakpoint_chain.back () == watchpoint_ptr); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression. | 
 |    If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static int | 
 | can_use_hardware_watchpoint (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals) | 
 | { | 
 |   int found_memory_cnt = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */ | 
 |   if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints) | 
 |     return 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_assert (!vals.empty ()); | 
 |   struct value *head = vals[0].get (); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon | 
 |      memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB.  If we | 
 |      find any register references or function calls, we can't use a | 
 |      hardware watchpoint. | 
 |  | 
 |      The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series | 
 |      of values, one holding the value of every subexpression.  (The | 
 |      expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and | 
 |      a*b+c.)  GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish | 
 |      the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues, | 
 |      register lvalues, computed values, etcetera.  So we can evaluate | 
 |      the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves | 
 |      behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the | 
 |      expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints. | 
 |  | 
 |      However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior | 
 |      function calls are special in any way.  So this function may not | 
 |      notice that an expression involving an inferior function call | 
 |      can't be watched with hardware watchpoints.  FIXME.  */ | 
 |   for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : vals) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct value *v = iter.get (); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (v->lval () == lval_memory) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (v != head && v->lazy ()) | 
 | 	    /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never | 
 | 	       needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g., | 
 | 	       `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a' | 
 | 	       in `a,b').  This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is | 
 | 	       lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway.  */ | 
 | 	    ; | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Ahh, memory we actually used!  Check if we can cover | 
 | 		 it with hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
 | 	      struct type *vtype = check_typedef (v->type ()); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it | 
 | 		 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a | 
 | 		 middle of some value chain.  */ | 
 | 	      if (v == head | 
 | 		  || (vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT | 
 | 		      && vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  CORE_ADDR vaddr = v->address (); | 
 | 		  int len; | 
 | 		  int num_regs; | 
 |  | 
 | 		  len = (target_exact_watchpoints | 
 | 			 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))? | 
 | 		    1 : v->type ()->length (); | 
 |  | 
 | 		  num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len); | 
 | 		  if (!num_regs) | 
 | 		    return 0; | 
 | 		  else | 
 | 		    found_memory_cnt += num_regs; | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else if (v->lval () != not_lval && !v->deprecated_modifiable ()) | 
 | 	return 0;	/* These are values from the history (e.g., $1).  */ | 
 |       else if (v->lval () == lval_register) | 
 | 	return 0;	/* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint.  */ | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware | 
 |      watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it.  */ | 
 |   return found_memory_cnt; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal) | 
 | { | 
 |   watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Options for the watch, awatch, and rwatch commands.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | struct watch_options | 
 | { | 
 |   /* For -location.  */ | 
 |   bool location = false; | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Definitions of options for the "watch", "awatch", and "rwatch" commands. | 
 |  | 
 |    Historically GDB always accepted both '-location' and '-l' flags for | 
 |    these commands (both flags being synonyms).  When converting to the | 
 |    newer option scheme only '-location' is added here.  That's fine (for | 
 |    backward compatibility) as any non-ambiguous prefix of a flag will be | 
 |    accepted, so '-l', '-loc', are now all accepted. | 
 |  | 
 |    What this means is that, if in the future, we add any new flag here | 
 |    that starts with '-l' then this will break backward compatibility, so | 
 |    please, don't do that!  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static const gdb::option::option_def watch_option_defs[] = { | 
 |   gdb::option::flag_option_def<watch_options> { | 
 |     "location", | 
 |     [] (watch_options *opt) { return &opt->location; }, | 
 |     N_("\ | 
 | This evaluates EXPRESSION and watches the memory to which it refers.\n\ | 
 | -l can be used as a short form of -location."), | 
 |   }, | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Returns the option group used by 'watch', 'awatch', and 'rwatch' | 
 |    commands.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static gdb::option::option_def_group | 
 | make_watch_options_def_group (watch_options *opts) | 
 | { | 
 |   return {{watch_option_defs}, opts}; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then | 
 |    calls watch_command_1.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | watch_maybe_just_location (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   watch_options opts; | 
 |   auto grp = make_watch_options_def_group (&opts); | 
 |   gdb::option::process_options | 
 |     (&arg, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_OPERAND, grp); | 
 |   if (arg != nullptr && *arg == '\0') | 
 |     arg = nullptr; | 
 |  | 
 |   watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, opts.location, false); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Command completion for 'watch', 'awatch', and 'rwatch' commands.   */ | 
 | static void | 
 | watch_command_completer (struct cmd_list_element *ignore, | 
 | 			 completion_tracker &tracker, | 
 | 			 const char *text, const char * /*word*/) | 
 | { | 
 |   const auto group = make_watch_options_def_group (nullptr); | 
 |   if (gdb::option::complete_options | 
 |       (tracker, &text, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_OPERAND, group)) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   const char *word = advance_to_expression_complete_word_point (tracker, text); | 
 |   expression_completer (ignore, tracker, text, word); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | watch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal) | 
 | { | 
 |   watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | rwatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal) | 
 | { | 
 |   watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | awatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 | /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands | 
 |    in infcmd.c.  Here because it uses the mechanisms of | 
 |    breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | struct until_break_fsm : public thread_fsm | 
 | { | 
 |   /* The thread that was current when the command was executed.  */ | 
 |   int thread; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* The breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame, | 
 |      plus breakpoints at all the destination locations.  */ | 
 |   std::vector<breakpoint_up> breakpoints; | 
 |  | 
 |   until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread, | 
 | 		   std::vector<breakpoint_up> &&breakpoints) | 
 |     : thread_fsm (cmd_interp), | 
 |       thread (thread), | 
 |       breakpoints (std::move (breakpoints)) | 
 |   { | 
 |   } | 
 |  | 
 |   void clean_up (struct thread_info *thread) override; | 
 |   bool should_stop (struct thread_info *thread) override; | 
 |   enum async_reply_reason do_async_reply_reason () override; | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the | 
 |    until(location)/advance commands.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bool | 
 | until_break_fsm::should_stop (struct thread_info *tp) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (const breakpoint_up &bp : breakpoints) | 
 |     if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat, | 
 | 				bp.get ()) != NULL) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	set_finished (); | 
 | 	break; | 
 |       } | 
 |  | 
 |   return true; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the | 
 |    until(location)/advance commands.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | until_break_fsm::clean_up (struct thread_info *) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints.  */ | 
 |   breakpoints.clear (); | 
 |   delete_longjmp_breakpoint (thread); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the | 
 |    until(location)/advance commands.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | enum async_reply_reason | 
 | until_break_fsm::do_async_reply_reason () | 
 | { | 
 |   return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | until_break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere) | 
 | { | 
 |   frame_info_ptr frame; | 
 |   struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch; | 
 |   struct frame_id stack_frame_id; | 
 |   struct frame_id caller_frame_id; | 
 |   int thread; | 
 |   struct thread_info *tp; | 
 |  | 
 |   clear_proceed_status (0); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from | 
 |      this function.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   location_spec_up locspec = string_to_location_spec (&arg, current_language); | 
 |  | 
 |   std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals | 
 |     = (last_displayed_sal_is_valid () | 
 |        ? decode_line_1 (locspec.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL, | 
 | 			get_last_displayed_symtab (), | 
 | 			get_last_displayed_line ()) | 
 |        : decode_line_1 (locspec.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, | 
 | 			NULL, NULL, 0)); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (sals.empty ()) | 
 |     error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (*arg) | 
 |     error (_("Junk at end of arguments.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   tp = inferior_thread (); | 
 |   thread = tp->global_num; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain. | 
 |      Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it | 
 |      may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before | 
 |      that.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   frame = get_selected_frame (NULL); | 
 |   frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame); | 
 |   stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame); | 
 |   caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current | 
 |      one.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   std::vector<breakpoint_up> breakpoints; | 
 |  | 
 |   std::optional<delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup> lj_deleter; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct symtab_and_line sal2; | 
 |       struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch; | 
 |  | 
 |       sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0); | 
 |       sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame); | 
 |       caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame); | 
 |  | 
 |       breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint | 
 | 	= set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch, sal2, | 
 | 				    caller_frame_id, bp_until); | 
 |       breakpoints.emplace_back (std::move (caller_breakpoint)); | 
 |  | 
 |       set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, stack_frame_id); | 
 |       lj_deleter.emplace (thread); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location, we | 
 |      don't specify a frame at which we need to stop.  Otherwise, | 
 |      specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only at the | 
 |      very same frame.  */ | 
 |   frame_id stop_frame_id = anywhere ? null_frame_id : stack_frame_id; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (symtab_and_line &sal : sals) | 
 |     { | 
 |       resolve_sal_pc (&sal); | 
 |  | 
 |       breakpoint_up location_breakpoint | 
 | 	= set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal, | 
 | 				    stop_frame_id, bp_until); | 
 |       breakpoints.emplace_back (std::move (location_breakpoint)); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   tp->set_thread_fsm | 
 |     (std::unique_ptr<thread_fsm> | 
 |      (new until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num, | 
 | 			   std::move (breakpoints)))); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (lj_deleter) | 
 |     lj_deleter->release (); | 
 |  | 
 |   proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 | /* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static int | 
 | compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) a; | 
 |   uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) b; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (a->number < b->number) | 
 |     return -1; | 
 |   else if (a->number > b->number) | 
 |     return 1; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with | 
 |      the number 0.  */ | 
 |   if (ua < ub) | 
 |     return -1; | 
 |   return ua > ub ? 1 : 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Delete breakpoints by address or line.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | clear_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   int default_match; | 
 |  | 
 |   std::vector<symtab_and_line> decoded_sals; | 
 |   symtab_and_line last_sal; | 
 |   gdb::array_view<symtab_and_line> sals; | 
 |   if (arg) | 
 |     { | 
 |       decoded_sals | 
 | 	= decode_line_with_current_source (arg, | 
 | 					   (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE | 
 | 					    | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE)); | 
 |       default_match = 0; | 
 |       sals = decoded_sals; | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values | 
 | 	 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.  If the | 
 | 	 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0.  */ | 
 |       last_sal = get_last_displayed_sal (); | 
 |       if (last_sal.symtab == 0) | 
 | 	error (_("No source file specified.")); | 
 |  | 
 |       default_match = 1; | 
 |       sals = last_sal; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here.  That's not as bad as it | 
 |      seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both | 
 |      file/line and pc set.  So, if clear is given file/line, we can | 
 |      match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all. | 
 |  | 
 |      We only support clearing given the address explicitly  | 
 |      present in breakpoint table.  Say, we've set breakpoint  | 
 |      at file:line.  There were several PC values for that file:line, | 
 |      due to optimization, all in one block. | 
 |  | 
 |      We've picked one PC value.  If "clear" is issued with another | 
 |      PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't | 
 |      be cleared.  We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but  | 
 |      since the other PC value is never presented to user, user | 
 |      can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important | 
 |      to support that.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it.  Do | 
 |      it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that | 
 |      from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one | 
 |      breakpoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   std::vector<struct breakpoint *> found; | 
 |   for (const auto &sal : sals) | 
 |     { | 
 |       const char *sal_fullname; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc. | 
 | 	 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line. | 
 | 	 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line | 
 | 	 or at default pc. | 
 |  | 
 | 	 defaulting    sal.pc != 0    tests to do | 
 |  | 
 | 	 0              1             pc | 
 | 	 1              1             pc _and_ line | 
 | 	 0              0             line | 
 | 	 1              0             <can't happen> */ | 
 |  | 
 |       sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL | 
 | 		      ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab)); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'.  */ | 
 |       for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  int match = 0; | 
 | 	  /* Are we going to delete b?  */ | 
 | 	  if (b.type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (&b) | 
 | 	      && user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      for (bp_location &loc : b.locations ()) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC | 
 | 		     match.  This matches historical gdb behavior.  */ | 
 | 		  int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line | 
 | 				  && sal.pc | 
 | 				  && (loc.pspace == sal.pspace) | 
 | 				  && (loc.address == sal.pc) | 
 | 				  && (!section_is_overlay (loc.section) | 
 | 				      || loc.section == sal.section)); | 
 | 		  int line_match = 0; | 
 |  | 
 | 		  if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line) | 
 | 		      && loc.symtab != NULL | 
 | 		      && sal_fullname != NULL | 
 | 		      && sal.pspace == loc.pspace | 
 | 		      && loc.line_number == sal.line | 
 | 		      && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc.symtab), | 
 | 				       sal_fullname) == 0) | 
 | 		    line_match = 1; | 
 |  | 
 | 		  if (pc_match || line_match) | 
 | 		    { | 
 | 		      match = 1; | 
 | 		      break; | 
 | 		    } | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	    } | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (match) | 
 | 	    found.push_back (&b); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Now go through the 'found' chain and delete them.  */ | 
 |   if (found.empty ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (arg) | 
 | 	error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	error (_("No breakpoint at this line.")); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Remove duplicates from the vec.  */ | 
 |   std::sort (found.begin (), found.end (), | 
 | 	     [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b) | 
 | 	     { | 
 | 	       return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) < 0; | 
 | 	     }); | 
 |   found.erase (std::unique (found.begin (), found.end (), | 
 | 			    [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b) | 
 | 			    { | 
 | 			      return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) == 0; | 
 | 			    }), | 
 | 	       found.end ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (found.size () > 1) | 
 |     from_tty = 1;	/* Always report if deleted more than one.  */ | 
 |   if (from_tty) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (found.size () == 1) | 
 | 	gdb_printf (_("Deleted breakpoint ")); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	gdb_printf (_("Deleted breakpoints ")); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint *iter : found) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (from_tty) | 
 | 	gdb_printf ("%d ", iter->number); | 
 |       delete_breakpoint (iter); | 
 |     } | 
 |   if (from_tty) | 
 |     gdb_putc ('\n'); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and | 
 |    all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not. | 
 |    This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat *bs) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (; bs; bs = bs->next) | 
 |     if (bs->breakpoint_at | 
 | 	&& bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del | 
 | 	&& bs->stop) | 
 |       delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at); | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 |     if (b.disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) | 
 |       delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* A comparison function for bp_location pointers A and B being interfaced to | 
 |    std::sort, for instance to sort an std::vector<bp_location *>.  Sort | 
 |    elements: | 
 |    - primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what bl_address_is_meaningful | 
 |      says), | 
 |    - secondarily by ordering first permanent elements, and | 
 |    - tertiarily just ensuring the array is sorted in a stable way despite | 
 |      std::sort being an unstable algorithm.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | bp_location_ptr_is_less_than (const bp_location *a, const bp_location *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (a->address != b->address) | 
 |     return a->address < b->address; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping | 
 |      locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment) | 
 |      grouped.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num) | 
 |     return a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Sort permanent breakpoints first.  */ | 
 |   if (a->permanent != b->permanent) | 
 |     return a->permanent > b->permanent; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Sort by type in order to make duplicate determination easier. | 
 |      See update_global_location_list.  This is kept in sync with | 
 |      breakpoint_locations_match.  */ | 
 |   if (a->loc_type < b->loc_type) | 
 |     return true; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Likewise, for range-breakpoints, sort by length.  */ | 
 |   if (a->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | 
 |       && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | 
 |       && a->length < b->length) | 
 |     return true; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs | 
 |      where A and B memory inside GDB can differ.  Breakpoint locations of | 
 |      the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number) | 
 |     return a->owner->number < b->owner->number; | 
 |  | 
 |   return a < b; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* A comparison function for bp_locations A and B being interfaced to | 
 |    std::sort, for instance to sort an std::vector<bp_location>.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | bp_location_is_less_than (const bp_location &a, const bp_location &b) | 
 | { | 
 |   return bp_location_ptr_is_less_than (&a, &b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and | 
 |    bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current | 
 |    content of the bp_locations array.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = 0; | 
 |   bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       CORE_ADDR start, end, addr; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       start = bl->target_info.placed_address; | 
 |       end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len; | 
 |  | 
 |       gdb_assert (bl->address >= start); | 
 |       addr = bl->address - start; | 
 |       if (addr > bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max) | 
 | 	bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = addr; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |       gdb_assert (bl->address < end); | 
 |       addr = end - bl->address; | 
 |       if (addr > bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max) | 
 | 	bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr; | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | download_tracepoint_locations (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN; | 
 |  | 
 |   scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_tracepoints ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       bool bp_location_downloaded = false; | 
 |  | 
 |       if ((b.type == bp_fast_tracepoint | 
 | 	   ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints | 
 | 	   : !may_insert_tracepoints)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (target_can_download_tracepoint ()) | 
 | 	    can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE; | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE) | 
 | 	break; | 
 |  | 
 |       for (bp_location &bl : b.locations ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so | 
 | 	     should_be_inserted is equivalent to | 
 | 	     unduplicated_should_be_inserted.  */ | 
 | 	  if (!should_be_inserted (&bl) || bl.inserted) | 
 | 	    continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl.pspace); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  target_download_tracepoint (&bl); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  bl.inserted = 1; | 
 | 	  bp_location_downloaded = true; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       tracepoint &t = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint &> (b); | 
 |       t.number_on_target = b.number; | 
 |       if (bp_location_downloaded) | 
 | 	notify_breakpoint_modified (&b); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right) | 
 | { | 
 |   const int left_inserted = left->inserted; | 
 |   const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate; | 
 |   const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update; | 
 |   const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated.  */ | 
 |   if (is_tracepoint (left->owner)) | 
 |     gdb_assert (!left->duplicate); | 
 |   if (is_tracepoint (right->owner)) | 
 |     gdb_assert (!right->duplicate); | 
 |  | 
 |   left->inserted = right->inserted; | 
 |   left->duplicate = right->duplicate; | 
 |   left->needs_update = right->needs_update; | 
 |   left->target_info = right->target_info; | 
 |   right->inserted = left_inserted; | 
 |   right->duplicate = left_duplicate; | 
 |   right->needs_update = left_needs_update; | 
 |   right->target_info = left_target_info; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS.  This is called | 
 |    once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating | 
 |    conditions on the target's side.  Such conditions need to be updated on | 
 |    the target.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   CORE_ADDR address = 0; | 
 |   int pspace_num; | 
 |  | 
 |   address = bl->address; | 
 |   pspace_num = bl->pspace->num; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* This is only meaningful if the target is | 
 |      evaluating conditions and if the user has | 
 |      opted for condition evaluation on the target's | 
 |      side.  */ | 
 |   if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | 
 |       || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and | 
 |      the same program space as the location | 
 |      as "its condition has changed".  We need to | 
 |      update the conditions on the target's side.  */ | 
 |   for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations_at_addr (address)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner) | 
 | 	  || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Flag the location appropriately.  We use a different state to | 
 | 	 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations | 
 | 	 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace.  This is so | 
 | 	 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations | 
 | 	 that have already been marked.  */ | 
 |       loc->condition_changed = condition_updated; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well.  We will compute | 
 | 	 it later on.  */ | 
 |       loc->cond_bytecode.reset (); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints | 
 |    deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which | 
 |    locations are duplicate of which. | 
 |  | 
 |    The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or | 
 |    shall be inserted now.  See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more | 
 |    info.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update.  */ | 
 |   CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0; | 
 |   /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update.  */ | 
 |   int last_pspace_num = -1; | 
 |  | 
 |   breakpoint_debug_printf ("insert_mode = %s", | 
 | 			   ugll_insert_mode_text (insert_mode)); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Used in the duplicates detection below.  When iterating over all | 
 |      bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address. | 
 |      Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never | 
 |      duplicates of each other.  Keep one pointer for each type of | 
 |      breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations | 
 |      once.  */ | 
 |   struct bp_location *bp_loc_first;  /* breakpoint */ | 
 |   struct bp_location *wp_loc_first;  /* hardware watchpoint */ | 
 |   struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */ | 
 |   struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */ | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly | 
 |      built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS.  */ | 
 |   std::vector<bp_location *> old_locations = std::move (bp_locations); | 
 |   bp_locations.clear (); | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     for (bp_location &loc : b.locations ()) | 
 |       bp_locations.push_back (&loc); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* See if we need to "upgrade" a software breakpoint to a hardware | 
 |      breakpoint.  Do this before deciding whether locations are | 
 |      duplicates.  Also do this before sorting because sorting order | 
 |      depends on location type.  */ | 
 |   for (bp_location *loc : bp_locations) | 
 |     if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc)) | 
 | 	handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (loc); | 
 |  | 
 |   std::sort (bp_locations.begin (), bp_locations.end (), | 
 | 	     bp_location_ptr_is_less_than); | 
 |  | 
 |   bp_locations_target_extensions_update (); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the | 
 |      new list, and therefore should be freed.  Note that it's not | 
 |      necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior -- | 
 |      if there's another location at the same address (previously | 
 |      marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the | 
 |      location. | 
 |       | 
 |      LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current | 
 |      and former bp_location array state respectively.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   size_t loc_i = 0; | 
 |   for (bp_location *old_loc : old_locations) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations.  If | 
 | 	 not, we have to free it.  */ | 
 |       bool found_object = false; | 
 |       /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target.  */ | 
 |       bool keep_in_target = false; | 
 |       bool removed = false; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed. | 
 | 	 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC.  */ | 
 |       while (loc_i < bp_locations.size () | 
 | 	     && bp_locations[loc_i]->address < old_loc->address) | 
 | 	loc_i++; | 
 |  | 
 |       for (size_t loc2_i = loc_i; | 
 | 	   (loc2_i < bp_locations.size () | 
 | 	    && bp_locations[loc2_i]->address == old_loc->address); | 
 | 	   loc2_i++) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated | 
 | 	     location that had its condition modified.  If so, we want to send | 
 | 	     its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking | 
 | 	     place there.  */ | 
 | 	  if (bp_locations[loc2_i]->condition_changed == condition_modified | 
 | 	      && (last_addr != old_loc->address | 
 | 		  || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num)) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      force_breakpoint_reinsertion (bp_locations[loc2_i]); | 
 | 	      last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num; | 
 | 	    } | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (bp_locations[loc2_i] == old_loc) | 
 | 	    found_object = true; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't | 
 | 	 have to go through updates again.  */ | 
 |       last_addr = old_loc->address; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations.  */ | 
 |       if (!found_object) | 
 | 	force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if | 
 | 	 there's maybe a new location at the same address.  If so, | 
 | 	 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one.  This is | 
 | 	 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint | 
 | 	 at certain location is not inserted.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |       if (old_loc->inserted) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove | 
 | 	     it.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc)) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* The location is still present in the location list, | 
 | 		 and still should be inserted.  Don't do anything.  */ | 
 | 	      keep_in_target = true; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the | 
 | 		 target since it may have been disabled.  We proceed to | 
 | 		 remove its target-side condition.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	      /* The location is either no longer present, or got | 
 | 		 disabled.  See if there's another location at the | 
 | 		 same address, in which case we don't need to remove | 
 | 		 this one from the target.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	      /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint.  */ | 
 | 	      if (bl_address_is_meaningful (old_loc)) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  for (size_t loc2_i = loc_i; | 
 | 		       (loc2_i < bp_locations.size () | 
 | 			&& bp_locations[loc2_i]->address == old_loc->address); | 
 | 		       loc2_i++) | 
 | 		    { | 
 | 		      bp_location *loc2 = bp_locations[loc2_i]; | 
 |  | 
 | 		      if (loc2 == old_loc) | 
 | 			continue; | 
 |  | 
 | 		      if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc)) | 
 | 			{ | 
 | 			  /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to | 
 | 			     access watchpoints, if the former are not | 
 | 			     supported, but the latter are.  */ | 
 | 			  if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner)) | 
 | 			    { | 
 | 			      gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner)); | 
 | 			      loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type; | 
 | 			    } | 
 |  | 
 | 			  /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check | 
 | 			     if it should be inserted in case it will be | 
 | 			     unduplicated.  */ | 
 | 			  if (unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2)) | 
 | 			    { | 
 | 			      swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2); | 
 | 			      keep_in_target = true; | 
 | 			      break; | 
 | 			    } | 
 | 			} | 
 | 		    } | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	    } | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (!keep_in_target) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc)) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  /* This is just about all we can do.  We could keep | 
 | 		     this location on the global list, and try to | 
 | 		     remove it next time, but there's no particular | 
 | 		     reason why we will succeed next time. | 
 | 		      | 
 | 		     Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still | 
 | 		     valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint | 
 | 		     only after calling us.  */ | 
 | 		  warning (_("error removing breakpoint %d at %s"), | 
 | 			   old_loc->owner->number, | 
 | 			   paddress (old_loc->gdbarch, old_loc->address)); | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	      removed = true; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!found_object) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p () | 
 | 	      && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc)) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* This location was removed from the target.  In | 
 | 		 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where | 
 | 		 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that | 
 | 		 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later. | 
 | 		 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such | 
 | 		 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this | 
 | 		 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it | 
 | 		 after we see some number of events.  The theory here | 
 | 		 is that reporting of events should, "on the average", | 
 | 		 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all | 
 | 		 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer | 
 | 		 need to keep this breakpoint location around.  We | 
 | 		 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of | 
 | 		 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint | 
 | 		 SIGTRAP. | 
 |  | 
 | 		 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on | 
 | 		 decr_pc_after_break targets. | 
 |  | 
 | 		 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux, | 
 | 		 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP, | 
 | 		 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too | 
 | 		 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report | 
 | 		 a random SIGTRAP to the user.  When the user resumes | 
 | 		 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash | 
 | 		 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently | 
 | 		 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the | 
 | 		 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a | 
 | 		 one-byte instruction.  This was actually seen happen | 
 | 		 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on | 
 | 		 targets that do not support new thread events, like | 
 | 		 remote, due to the heuristic depending on | 
 | 		 thread_count. | 
 |  | 
 | 		 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap | 
 | 		 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when | 
 | 		 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs | 
 | 		 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble. | 
 |  | 
 | 		 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always | 
 | 		 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to | 
 | 		 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations | 
 | 		 around.  We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint | 
 | 		 traps we can no longer explain.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | 	      process_stratum_target *proc_target = nullptr; | 
 | 	      for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ()) | 
 | 		if (inf->pspace == old_loc->pspace) | 
 | 		  { | 
 | 		    proc_target = inf->process_target (); | 
 | 		    break; | 
 | 		  } | 
 | 	      if (proc_target != nullptr) | 
 | 		old_loc->events_till_retirement | 
 | 		  = 3 * (thread_count (proc_target) + 1); | 
 | 	      else | 
 | 		old_loc->events_till_retirement = 1; | 
 | 	      old_loc->owner = NULL; | 
 |  | 
 | 	      moribund_locations.push_back (old_loc); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      old_loc->owner = NULL; | 
 | 	      decref_bp_location (&old_loc); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the | 
 |      first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates".  This is so | 
 |      that the bpt instruction is only inserted once.  If we have a | 
 |      permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the | 
 |      official one, and the rest as duplicates.  Permanent breakpoints | 
 |      are sorted first for the same address. | 
 |  | 
 |      Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the | 
 |      watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   bp_loc_first = NULL; | 
 |   wp_loc_first = NULL; | 
 |   awp_loc_first = NULL; | 
 |   rwp_loc_first = NULL; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always | 
 | 	 non-NULL.  */ | 
 |       struct bp_location **loc_first_p; | 
 |       breakpoint *b = loc->owner; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc) | 
 | 	  || !bl_address_is_meaningful (loc) | 
 | 	  /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are | 
 | 	   never duplicated.  See the comments in field `duplicate' of | 
 | 	   `struct bp_location'.  */ | 
 | 	  || is_tracepoint (b)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* Clear the condition modification flag.  */ | 
 | 	  loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged; | 
 | 	  continue; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint) | 
 | 	loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first; | 
 |       else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint) | 
 | 	loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first; | 
 |       else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint) | 
 | 	loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first; | 
 |       else | 
 | 	loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (*loc_first_p == NULL | 
 | 	  || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section) | 
 | 	  || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  *loc_first_p = loc; | 
 | 	  loc->duplicate = 0; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      loc->needs_update = 1; | 
 | 	      /* Clear the condition modification flag.  */ | 
 | 	      loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  continue; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 |       /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location | 
 | 	 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one. | 
 | 	 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted.  */ | 
 |       if (loc->inserted) | 
 | 	swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p); | 
 |       loc->duplicate = 1; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Clear the condition modification flag.  */ | 
 |       loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT) | 
 | 	insert_breakpoint_locations (); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new | 
 | 	     locations, we may still need to update conditions on the | 
 | 	     target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted | 
 | 	     if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions.  We | 
 | 	     only update conditions for locations that are marked | 
 | 	     "needs_update".  */ | 
 | 	  update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT) | 
 |     download_tracepoint_locations (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint_retire_moribund (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (int ix = 0; ix < moribund_locations.size (); ++ix) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct bp_location *loc = moribund_locations[ix]; | 
 |       if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  decref_bp_location (&loc); | 
 | 	  unordered_remove (moribund_locations, ix); | 
 | 	  --ix; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode) | 
 | { | 
 |  | 
 |   try | 
 |     { | 
 |       update_global_location_list (insert_mode); | 
 |     } | 
 |   catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) | 
 |     { | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Clear BKP from a BPS.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat *bps, struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
 | { | 
 |   bpstat *bs; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next) | 
 |     if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	bs->breakpoint_at = NULL; | 
 | 	bs->old_val = NULL; | 
 | 	/* bs->commands will be freed later.  */ | 
 |       } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | code_breakpoint::say_where () const | 
 | { | 
 |   struct value_print_options opts; | 
 |  | 
 |   get_user_print_options (&opts); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a | 
 |      single string.  */ | 
 |   if (!this->has_locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based | 
 | 	 on extra_string.  If this is non-NULL, it contains either | 
 | 	 a condition or dprintf arguments.  */ | 
 |       if (extra_string == NULL) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  gdb_printf (_(" (%s) pending."), locspec->to_string ()); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else if (type == bp_dprintf) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  gdb_printf (_(" (%s,%s) pending."), | 
 | 		      locspec->to_string (), | 
 | 		      extra_string.get ()); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  gdb_printf (_(" (%s %s) pending."), | 
 | 		      locspec->to_string (), | 
 | 		      extra_string.get ()); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       const bp_location &bl = this->first_loc (); | 
 |       if (opts.addressprint || bl.symtab == nullptr) | 
 | 	gdb_printf (" at %ps", | 
 | 		    styled_string (address_style.style (), | 
 | 				   paddress (bl.gdbarch, | 
 | 					     bl.address))); | 
 |       if (bl.symtab != NULL) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* If there is a single location, we can print the location | 
 | 	     more nicely.  */ | 
 | 	  if (!this->has_multiple_locations ()) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      const char *filename | 
 | 		= symtab_to_filename_for_display (bl.symtab); | 
 | 	      gdb_printf (": file %ps, line %ps.", | 
 | 			  styled_string (file_name_style.style (), | 
 | 					 filename), | 
 | 			  styled_string (line_number_style.style (), | 
 | 					 pulongest (bl.line_number))); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a | 
 | 	       different file name, and this at least reflects the | 
 | 	       real situation somewhat.  */ | 
 | 	    gdb_printf (": %s.", locspec->to_string ()); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (this->has_multiple_locations ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  int n = std::distance (m_locations.begin (), m_locations.end ()); | 
 | 	  gdb_printf (" (%d locations)", n); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bp_location_range | 
 | breakpoint::locations () const | 
 | { | 
 |   return bp_location_range (m_locations.begin (), m_locations.end ()); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | struct bp_location * | 
 | breakpoint::allocate_location () | 
 | { | 
 |   return new bp_location (this); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint::add_location (bp_location &loc) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_assert (loc.owner == this); | 
 |   gdb_assert (!loc.is_linked ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   auto ub = std::upper_bound (m_locations.begin (), m_locations.end (), | 
 | 			      loc, | 
 | 			      bp_location_is_less_than); | 
 |   m_locations.insert (ub, loc); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint::unadd_location (bp_location &loc) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_assert (loc.owner == this); | 
 |   gdb_assert (loc.is_linked ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   m_locations.erase (m_locations.iterator_to (loc)); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \ | 
 |   gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called") | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | breakpoint::insert_location (struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | breakpoint::remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 			     enum remove_bp_reason reason) | 
 | { | 
 |   internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | breakpoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 			    const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 			    CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
 | 			    const target_waitstatus &ws) | 
 | { | 
 |   internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | breakpoint::resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | enum print_stop_action | 
 | breakpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const | 
 | { | 
 |   internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint::print_mention () const | 
 | { | 
 |   internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const | 
 | { | 
 |   internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Default breakpoint_ops methods.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | code_breakpoint::re_set (struct program_space *pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* FIXME: is this still reachable?  */ | 
 |   if (breakpoint_location_spec_empty_p (this)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Anything without a location can't be re-set.  */ | 
 |       delete_breakpoint (this); | 
 |       return; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   re_set_default (pspace); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | code_breakpoint::insert_location (struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address; | 
 |  | 
 |   bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr); | 
 |   bl->target_info.placed_address = addr; | 
 |  | 
 |   int result; | 
 |   if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 |     result = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info); | 
 |   else | 
 |     result = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (result == 0 && bl->probe.prob != nullptr) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore | 
 | 	 if needed.  */ | 
 |       bl->probe.prob->set_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return result; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | code_breakpoint::remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 				  enum remove_bp_reason reason) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (bl->probe.prob != nullptr) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location.  */ | 
 |       bl->probe.prob->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 |     return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info); | 
 |   else | 
 |     return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | code_breakpoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 				 const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 				 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
 | 				 const target_waitstatus &ws) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (ws.kind () != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED | 
 |       || ws.sig () != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) | 
 |     return 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace.get (), bl->address, | 
 | 				 aspace, bp_addr)) | 
 |     return 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (overlay_debugging		/* unmapped overlay section */ | 
 |       && section_is_overlay (bl->section) | 
 |       && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | 
 |     return 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   return 1; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | dprintf_breakpoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 				    const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 				    CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
 | 				    const target_waitstatus &ws) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent | 
 |       && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop.  If we see a trap | 
 | 	 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to | 
 | 	 be set at the same address.  */ | 
 |       return 0; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return this->ordinary_breakpoint::breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | ordinary_breakpoint::resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_assert (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint); | 
 |  | 
 |   return 1; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | enum print_stop_action | 
 | ordinary_breakpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const | 
 | { | 
 |   const struct bp_location *bl; | 
 |   int bp_temp; | 
 |   struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |  | 
 |   bl = bs->bp_location_at.get (); | 
 |  | 
 |   bp_temp = disposition == disp_del; | 
 |   if (bl->address != bl->requested_address) | 
 |     breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address, | 
 | 				   bl->address, | 
 | 				   number, true); | 
 |   annotate_breakpoint (number); | 
 |   maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       uiout->field_string ("reason", | 
 | 			   async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT)); | 
 |       uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (disposition)); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bp_temp) | 
 |     uiout->text ("Temporary breakpoint "); | 
 |   else | 
 |     uiout->text ("Breakpoint "); | 
 |   print_num_locno (bs, uiout); | 
 |   uiout->text (", "); | 
 |  | 
 |   return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | ordinary_breakpoint::print_mention () const | 
 | { | 
 |   if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   switch (type) | 
 |     { | 
 |     case bp_breakpoint: | 
 |     case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: | 
 |       if (disposition == disp_del) | 
 | 	gdb_printf (_("Temporary breakpoint")); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint")); | 
 |       gdb_printf (_(" %d"), number); | 
 |       if (type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver) | 
 | 	gdb_printf (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver")); | 
 |       break; | 
 |     case bp_hardware_breakpoint: | 
 |       gdb_printf (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), number); | 
 |       break; | 
 |     case bp_dprintf: | 
 |       gdb_printf (_("Dprintf %d"), number); | 
 |       break; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   say_where (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | ordinary_breakpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const | 
 | { | 
 |   if (type == bp_breakpoint && disposition == disp_del) | 
 |     gdb_printf (fp, "tbreak"); | 
 |   else if (type == bp_breakpoint) | 
 |     gdb_printf (fp, "break"); | 
 |   else if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint | 
 | 	   && disposition == disp_del) | 
 |     gdb_printf (fp, "thbreak"); | 
 |   else if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 |     gdb_printf (fp, "hbreak"); | 
 |   else | 
 |     internal_error (_("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) type); | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_printf (fp, " %s", locspec->to_string ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending.  It might | 
 |      contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user.  */ | 
 |   if (!this->has_locations () && extra_string != NULL) | 
 |     gdb_printf (fp, " %s", extra_string.get ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   print_recreate_thread (fp); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> | 
 | code_breakpoint::decode_location_spec (location_spec *locspec, | 
 | 				       program_space *search_pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (locspec->type () == PROBE_LOCATION_SPEC) | 
 |     return bkpt_probe_decode_location_spec (this, locspec, search_pspace); | 
 |  | 
 |   struct linespec_result canonical; | 
 |  | 
 |   decode_line_full (locspec, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace, | 
 | 		    NULL, 0, &canonical, multiple_symbols_all, | 
 | 		    filter.get ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs.  */ | 
 |   gdb_assert (canonical.lsals.size () < 2); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!canonical.lsals.empty ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0]; | 
 |       return std::move (lsal.sals); | 
 |     } | 
 |   return {}; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | internal_breakpoint::re_set (struct program_space *pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   switch (type) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they | 
 | 	 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set.  */ | 
 |     case bp_overlay_event: | 
 |     case bp_longjmp_master: | 
 |     case bp_std_terminate_master: | 
 |     case bp_exception_master: | 
 |       delete_breakpoint (this); | 
 |       break; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior | 
 | 	 starts and we really don't want to touch it.  */ | 
 |     case bp_shlib_event: | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special.  Once | 
 | 	 it is set up, we do not want to touch it.  */ | 
 |     case bp_thread_event: | 
 |       break; | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | internal_breakpoint::check_status (bpstat *bs) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (type == bp_shlib_event) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of | 
 | 	 events.  This allows the user to get control and place | 
 | 	 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded | 
 | 	 objects (among other things).  */ | 
 |       bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events != 0; | 
 |       bs->print = stop_on_solib_events != 0; | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     bs->stop = false; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | enum print_stop_action | 
 | internal_breakpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const | 
 | { | 
 |   switch (type) | 
 |     { | 
 |     case bp_shlib_event: | 
 |       /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events | 
 | 	 variable?  (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due | 
 | 	 to shlib event" message.) */ | 
 |       print_solib_event (false); | 
 |       break; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_thread_event: | 
 |       /* Not sure how we will get here. | 
 | 	 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints.  */ | 
 |       gdb_printf (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n")); | 
 |       break; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_overlay_event: | 
 |       /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these.  */ | 
 |       gdb_printf (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n")); | 
 |       break; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_longjmp_master: | 
 |       /* These should never be enabled.  */ | 
 |       gdb_printf (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n")); | 
 |       break; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_std_terminate_master: | 
 |       /* These should never be enabled.  */ | 
 |       gdb_printf (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: " | 
 | 		    "gdb should not stop!\n")); | 
 |       break; | 
 |  | 
 |     case bp_exception_master: | 
 |       /* These should never be enabled.  */ | 
 |       gdb_printf (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: " | 
 | 		    "gdb should not stop!\n")); | 
 |       break; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return PRINT_NOTHING; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | internal_breakpoint::print_mention () const | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Nothing to mention.  These breakpoints are internal.  */ | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | momentary_breakpoint::re_set (struct program_space *pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step | 
 |      over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints. | 
 |      Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain | 
 |      or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable.  */ | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | momentary_breakpoint::check_status (bpstat *bs) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Nothing.  The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop.  */ | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | enum print_stop_action | 
 | momentary_breakpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const | 
 | { | 
 |   return PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | momentary_breakpoint::print_mention () const | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Nothing to mention.  These breakpoints are internal.  */ | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists. | 
 |  | 
 |    It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed | 
 |    breakpoints.  This is OK as they get all removed altogether.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint () | 
 | { | 
 |   thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (this->thread); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (tp != NULL) | 
 |     tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location_spec (location_spec *locspec, | 
 | 					   struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
 | 					   struct program_space *search_pspace) | 
 |  | 
 | { | 
 |   struct linespec_sals lsal; | 
 |  | 
 |   lsal.sals = parse_probes (locspec, search_pspace, canonical); | 
 |   lsal.canonical = xstrdup (canonical->locspec->to_string ()); | 
 |   canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal)); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static std::vector<symtab_and_line> | 
 | bkpt_probe_decode_location_spec (struct breakpoint *b, | 
 | 				 location_spec *locspec, | 
 | 				 program_space *search_pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals | 
 |     = parse_probes (locspec, search_pspace, NULL); | 
 |   if (sals.empty ()) | 
 |     error (_("probe not found")); | 
 |   return sals; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | tracepoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
 | 			    const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
 | 			    const target_waitstatus &ws) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at | 
 |      tracepoints.  */ | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | tracepoint::print_one_detail (struct ui_out *uiout) const | 
 | { | 
 |   if (!static_trace_marker_id.empty ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       gdb_assert (type == bp_static_tracepoint | 
 | 		  || type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint); | 
 |  | 
 |       uiout->message ("\tmarker id is %pF\n", | 
 | 		      string_field ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id", | 
 | 				    static_trace_marker_id.c_str ())); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | tracepoint::print_mention () const | 
 | { | 
 |   if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   switch (type) | 
 |     { | 
 |     case bp_tracepoint: | 
 |       gdb_printf (_("Tracepoint")); | 
 |       gdb_printf (_(" %d"), number); | 
 |       break; | 
 |     case bp_fast_tracepoint: | 
 |       gdb_printf (_("Fast tracepoint")); | 
 |       gdb_printf (_(" %d"), number); | 
 |       break; | 
 |     case bp_static_tracepoint: | 
 |     case bp_static_marker_tracepoint: | 
 |       gdb_printf (_("Static tracepoint")); | 
 |       gdb_printf (_(" %d"), number); | 
 |       break; | 
 |     default: | 
 |       internal_error (_("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) type); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   say_where (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | tracepoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const | 
 | { | 
 |   if (type == bp_fast_tracepoint) | 
 |     gdb_printf (fp, "ftrace"); | 
 |   else if (type == bp_static_tracepoint | 
 | 	   || type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint) | 
 |     gdb_printf (fp, "strace"); | 
 |   else if (type == bp_tracepoint) | 
 |     gdb_printf (fp, "trace"); | 
 |   else | 
 |     internal_error (_("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) type); | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_printf (fp, " %s", locspec->to_string ()); | 
 |   print_recreate_thread (fp); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (pass_count) | 
 |     gdb_printf (fp, "  passcount %d\n", pass_count); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | dprintf_breakpoint::re_set (struct program_space *pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   re_set_default (pspace); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands. | 
 |      2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine. | 
 |      3 - disconnect from target 1 | 
 |      4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands. | 
 |  | 
 |      After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to | 
 |      be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different | 
 |      answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands(). | 
 |      Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do | 
 |      it all the time.  */ | 
 |   update_dprintf_command_list (this); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "print_recreate" method for dprintf.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | dprintf_breakpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_printf (fp, "dprintf %s,%s", locspec->to_string (), extra_string.get ()); | 
 |   print_recreate_thread (fp); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Implement the "after_condition_true" method for dprintf. | 
 |  | 
 |    dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command | 
 |    list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the | 
 |    stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop.  This | 
 |    also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same | 
 |    address are all handled.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | dprintf_breakpoint::after_condition_true (struct bpstat *bs) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* dprintf's never cause a stop.  This wasn't set in the | 
 |      check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's | 
 |      condition not be evaluated.  */ | 
 |   bs->stop = false; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Run the command list here.  Take ownership of it instead of | 
 |      copying.  We never want these commands to run later in | 
 |      bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to | 
 |      be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the | 
 |      commands here throws.  */ | 
 |   counted_command_line cmds = std::move (bs->commands); | 
 |   gdb_assert (cmds != nullptr); | 
 |   execute_control_commands (cmds.get (), 0); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with | 
 |    markers (`-m').  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | strace_marker_create_sals_from_location_spec | 
 | 	(location_spec *locspec, | 
 | 	 struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
 | 	 struct program_space *search_pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct linespec_sals lsal; | 
 |   const char *arg_start, *arg; | 
 |  | 
 |   arg = arg_start = as_linespec_location_spec (locspec)->spec_string.get (); | 
 |   lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg); | 
 |  | 
 |   std::string str (arg_start, arg - arg_start); | 
 |   const char *ptr = str.c_str (); | 
 |   canonical->locspec | 
 |     = new_linespec_location_spec (&ptr, symbol_name_match_type::FULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   lsal.canonical = xstrdup (canonical->locspec->to_string ()); | 
 |   canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal)); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
 | 				      struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
 | 				      gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string, | 
 | 				      gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string, | 
 | 				      enum bptype type_wanted, | 
 | 				      enum bpdisp disposition, | 
 | 				      int thread, | 
 | 				      int task, int inferior, | 
 | 				      int ignore_count, | 
 | 				      int from_tty, int enabled, | 
 | 				      int internal, unsigned flags) | 
 | { | 
 |   const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical->lsals[0]; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id | 
 |      (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that | 
 |      breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly | 
 |      found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to | 
 |      expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS | 
 |      already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   for (size_t i = 0; i < lsal.sals.size (); i++) | 
 |     { | 
 |       location_spec_up locspec = canonical->locspec->clone (); | 
 |  | 
 |       std::unique_ptr<tracepoint> tp | 
 | 	(new tracepoint (gdbarch, | 
 | 			 type_wanted, | 
 | 			 lsal.sals[i], | 
 | 			 std::move (locspec), | 
 | 			 NULL, | 
 | 			 std::move (cond_string), | 
 | 			 std::move (extra_string), | 
 | 			 disposition, | 
 | 			 thread, task, inferior, ignore_count, | 
 | 			 from_tty, enabled, flags, | 
 | 			 canonical->special_display)); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with | 
 | 	 the same string id, if the user is creating a static | 
 | 	 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then | 
 | 	 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can | 
 | 	 try to match up which of the newly found markers | 
 | 	 corresponds to this one  */ | 
 |       tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i; | 
 |  | 
 |       install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (tp), 0); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> | 
 | static_marker_tracepoint::decode_location_spec (location_spec *locspec, | 
 | 						program_space *search_pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   const char *s = as_linespec_location_spec (locspec)->spec_string.get (); | 
 |  | 
 |   std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s); | 
 |   if (sals.size () > static_trace_marker_id_idx) | 
 |     { | 
 |       sals[0] = sals[static_trace_marker_id_idx]; | 
 |       sals.resize (1); | 
 |       return sals; | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     error (_("marker %s not found"), static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m').  */ | 
 | static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops = | 
 | { | 
 |   strace_marker_create_sals_from_location_spec, | 
 |   strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal, | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   return b->type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Notify interpreters and observers that breakpoint B was deleted.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | notify_breakpoint_deleted (breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   interps_notify_breakpoint_deleted (b); | 
 |   gdb::observers::breakpoint_deleted.notify (b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data | 
 |    structures.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb_assert (bpt != NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Has this bp already been deleted?  This can happen because | 
 |      multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's.  bpstat lists are | 
 |      especial culprits. | 
 |  | 
 |      One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp.  When | 
 |      the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of | 
 |      scope, and delete it.  We also delete its scope bp.  But the | 
 |      scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat. | 
 |      That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are | 
 |      deleted. | 
 |  | 
 |      A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in | 
 |      bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing | 
 |      bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's | 
 |      storage when no more references were extent.  A cheaper bandaid | 
 |      was chosen.  */ | 
 |   if (bpt->type == bp_none) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting | 
 |      of breakpoints gets resolved.  */ | 
 |   if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct breakpoint *related; | 
 |       struct watchpoint *w; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope) | 
 | 	w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (bpt->related_breakpoint); | 
 |       else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope) | 
 | 	w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (bpt); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	w = NULL; | 
 |       if (w != NULL) | 
 | 	watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring.  */ | 
 |       for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt; | 
 | 	   related = related->related_breakpoint); | 
 |       related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint; | 
 |       bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if | 
 |      update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations.  If there's | 
 |      a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created | 
 |      watchpoint.  In that case, don't announce the deletion.  */ | 
 |   if (bpt->number) | 
 |     notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt); | 
 |  | 
 |   breakpoint_chain.erase (breakpoint_chain.iterator_to (*bpt)); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's | 
 |      been freed.  */ | 
 |   /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's?  We just check stop_bpstat | 
 |      in all threads for now.  Note that we cannot just remove bpstats | 
 |      pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint | 
 |      commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here, | 
 |      then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in | 
 |      event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with | 
 |      commands won't work.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   iterate_over_threads ([&] (struct thread_info *th) | 
 |     { | 
 |       bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt); | 
 |       return false; | 
 |     }); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the | 
 |      global location list.  This will remove locations that used to | 
 |      belong to this breakpoint.  Do this before freeing the breakpoint | 
 |      itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner.  It | 
 |      might be better design to have location completely | 
 |      self-contained, but it's not the case now. | 
 |  | 
 |      Clear the location linked list first, otherwise, the intrusive_list | 
 |      destructor accesses the locations after they are freed.  */ | 
 |   bpt->clear_locations (); | 
 |   update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this | 
 |      same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage.  */ | 
 |   bpt->type = bp_none; | 
 |   delete bpt; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once | 
 |    for each of B and its related breakpoints.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b, | 
 | 				  gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct breakpoint *related; | 
 |  | 
 |   related = b; | 
 |   do | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct breakpoint *next; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED.  */ | 
 |       next = related->related_breakpoint; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (next == related) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* RELATED is the last ring entry.  */ | 
 | 	  function (related); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to | 
 | 	     B.  There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break | 
 | 	     out.  */ | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	function (related); | 
 |  | 
 |       related = next; | 
 |     } | 
 |   while (related != b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | delete_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   dont_repeat (); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (arg == 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       int breaks_to_delete = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Delete all breakpoints, watchpoints, tracepoints, and catchpoints | 
 | 	 if no argument.  Do not delete internal breakpoints, these have to | 
 | 	 be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument.  */ | 
 |       for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 | 	if (user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    breaks_to_delete = 1; | 
 | 	    break; | 
 | 	  } | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete.  */ | 
 |       if (!from_tty | 
 | 	  || (breaks_to_delete | 
 | 	      && query (_("Delete all breakpoints, watchpoints, tracepoints, " | 
 | 			  "and catchpoints? ")))) | 
 | 	for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 | 	  if (user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | 
 | 	    delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     map_breakpoint_numbers | 
 |       (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br) | 
 |        { | 
 | 	 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint); | 
 |        }); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending.  If | 
 |    PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are | 
 |    considered.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | 
 |     if ((pspace == NULL | 
 | 	 || loc.pspace == pspace) | 
 | 	&& !loc.shlib_disabled | 
 | 	&& !loc.pspace->executing_startup) | 
 |       return false; | 
 |   return true; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it. | 
 |    Return true if multiple fns in list LOCS have the same name. | 
 |    Null names are ignored.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | ambiguous_names_p (const bp_location_range &locs) | 
 | { | 
 |   gdb::unordered_set<std::string_view> htab; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (const bp_location &l : locs) | 
 |     { | 
 |       const char *name = l.function_name.get (); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them.  */ | 
 |       if (name == NULL) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!htab.insert (name).second) | 
 | 	return true; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return false; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well, | 
 |    and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at | 
 |    the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we | 
 |    checked.  Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is | 
 |    undesirable.  This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static | 
 |    tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints | 
 |    that have not been set by marker id.  Static tracepoint that have | 
 |    been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set. | 
 |    The heuristic is: | 
 |  | 
 |    1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at | 
 |    the old PC.  If one is found there, assume to be the same marker. | 
 |    If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the | 
 |    previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker | 
 |    in the sources, and output a warning. | 
 |  | 
 |    2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker | 
 |    at the new address of the old line number.  If one is found there, | 
 |    assume to be the same marker.  If the name / string id of the | 
 |    marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that | 
 |    means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a | 
 |    warning. | 
 |  | 
 |    3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it | 
 |    may mean the marker no longer exists.  But it may also just mean | 
 |    the code changed a bit.  Maybe the user added a few lines of code | 
 |    that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms).  Ask | 
 |    the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew | 
 |    it.  If found, update line number and address in the matching | 
 |    static tracepoint.  This will get confused if there's more than one | 
 |    marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised | 
 |    precisely because it confuses tools).  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static struct symtab_and_line | 
 | update_static_tracepoint (tracepoint *tp, struct symtab_and_line sal) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct static_tracepoint_marker marker; | 
 |   CORE_ADDR pc; | 
 |  | 
 |   pc = sal.pc; | 
 |   if (sal.line) | 
 |     find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (tp->static_trace_marker_id != marker.str_id) | 
 | 	warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"), | 
 | 		 tp->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str (), | 
 | 		 marker.str_id.c_str ()); | 
 |  | 
 |       tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id); | 
 |  | 
 |       return sal; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno.  Try looking it up | 
 |      by string ID.  */ | 
 |   if (!sal.explicit_pc | 
 |       && sal.line != 0 | 
 |       && sal.symtab != NULL | 
 |       && !tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers | 
 | 	= target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid | 
 | 	    (tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!markers.empty ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  struct symbol *sym; | 
 | 	  struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker; | 
 | 	  struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  tpmarker = &markers[0]; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (tpmarker->str_id); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not " | 
 | 		     "found at previous line number"), | 
 | 		   tp->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  symtab_and_line sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0); | 
 | 	  sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL); | 
 | 	  uiout->text ("Now in "); | 
 | 	  if (sym) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (), | 
 | 				   function_name_style.style ()); | 
 | 	      uiout->text (" at "); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  uiout->field_string ("file", | 
 | 			       symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab), | 
 | 			       file_name_style.style ()); | 
 | 	  uiout->text (":"); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname); | 
 | 	    } | 
 |  | 
 | 	  uiout->field_signed ("line", sal2.line, line_number_style.style ()); | 
 | 	  uiout->text ("\n"); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  tp->first_loc ().line_number = sal2.line; | 
 | 	  tp->first_loc ().symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  std::unique_ptr<explicit_location_spec> els | 
 | 	    (new explicit_location_spec | 
 | 	     (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab))); | 
 | 	  els->line_offset.offset = tp->first_loc ().line_number; | 
 | 	  els->line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  tp->locspec = std::move (els); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if | 
 | 	     so.  */ | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |   return sal; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Returns true iff location lists A and B are sufficiently same that | 
 |    we don't need to report breakpoint as changed.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | locations_are_equal (const bp_location_list &a, const bp_location_range &b) | 
 | { | 
 |   auto a_iter = a.begin (); | 
 |   auto b_iter = b.begin (); | 
 |  | 
 |   for (; a_iter != a.end () && b_iter != b.end (); ++a_iter, ++b_iter) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (a_iter->address != b_iter->address) | 
 | 	return false; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (a_iter->shlib_disabled != b_iter->shlib_disabled) | 
 | 	return false; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (a_iter->enabled != b_iter->enabled) | 
 | 	return false; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (a_iter->disabled_by_cond != b_iter->disabled_by_cond) | 
 | 	return false; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* When a breakpoint is set by address, it is not created as | 
 | 	 pending; but then during an solib event or the like it may | 
 | 	 acquire a symbol.  So, check this here.  */ | 
 |       if (a_iter->symbol != b_iter->symbol | 
 | 	  || a_iter->msymbol != b_iter->msymbol) | 
 | 	return false; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return (a_iter == a.end ()) == (b_iter == b.end ()); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | bp_location_list | 
 | breakpoint::steal_locations (program_space *pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (pspace == NULL) | 
 |     return std::move (m_locations); | 
 |  | 
 |   bp_location_list ret; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (auto it = m_locations.begin (); it != m_locations.end (); ) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (it->pspace == pspace) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  bp_location &loc = *it; | 
 | 	  it = m_locations.erase (it); | 
 | 	  ret.push_back (loc); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	++it; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return ret; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software | 
 |    breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END.  If SALS_END.NELTS is not | 
 |    zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint.  Only recreates locations for | 
 |    FILTER_PSPACE.  Locations of other program spaces are left | 
 |    untouched.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | update_breakpoint_locations (code_breakpoint *b, | 
 | 			     struct program_space *filter_pspace, | 
 | 			     gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals, | 
 | 			     gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals_end) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (!sals_end.empty () && (sals.size () != 1 || sals_end.size () != 1)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end | 
 | 	 location.  */ | 
 |       b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
 |       gdb_printf (gdb_stderr, | 
 | 		  _("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: " | 
 | 		    "multiple locations found\n"), | 
 | 		  b->number); | 
 |       return; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are | 
 |      pending, don't do anything.  This optimizes the common case where | 
 |      all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded. | 
 |      We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is | 
 |      loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the | 
 |      individual locations.  */ | 
 |   if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.empty ()) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   bp_location_list existing_locations = b->steal_locations (filter_pspace); | 
 |  | 
 |   for (const auto &sal : sals) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct bp_location *new_loc; | 
 |  | 
 |       switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace); | 
 |  | 
 |       new_loc = b->add_location (sal); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the | 
 | 	 old symtab.  */ | 
 |       if (b->cond_string != NULL) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  const char *s; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  s = b->cond_string.get (); | 
 | 	  try | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sal.pc, | 
 | 					   block_for_pc (sal.pc), | 
 | 					   0); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      new_loc->disabled_by_cond = true; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!sals_end.empty ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end[0]); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  new_loc->length = end - sals[0].pc + 1; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing | 
 |      breakpoints. | 
 |  | 
 |      If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name, | 
 |      e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work. | 
 |      Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things | 
 |      may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer | 
 |      often enough until a better solution is found.  */ | 
 |   bool have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->locations ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   for (const bp_location &e : existing_locations) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (e.function_name == nullptr || e.enabled) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (have_ambiguous_names) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  for (bp_location &l : b->locations ()) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Ignore software vs hardware location type at | 
 | 		 this point, because with "set breakpoint | 
 | 		 auto-hw", after a re-set, locations that were | 
 | 		 hardware can end up as software, or vice versa. | 
 | 		 As mentioned above, this is an heuristic and in | 
 | 		 practice should give the correct answer often | 
 | 		 enough.  */ | 
 | 	      if (breakpoint_locations_match (&e, &l, true)) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  l.enabled = e.enabled; | 
 | 		  break; | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |       else | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  for (bp_location &l : b->locations ()) | 
 | 	    if (l.function_name | 
 | 		&& strcmp (e.function_name.get (), | 
 | 			   l.function_name.get ()) == 0) | 
 | 	      { | 
 | 		l.enabled = e.enabled; | 
 | 		break; | 
 | 	      } | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->locations ())) | 
 |     notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCSPEC. | 
 |    On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> | 
 | code_breakpoint::location_spec_to_sals (location_spec *locspec, | 
 | 					struct program_space *search_pspace, | 
 | 					int *found) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct gdb_exception exception; | 
 |  | 
 |   std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals; | 
 |  | 
 |   try | 
 |     { | 
 |       sals = decode_location_spec (locspec, search_pspace); | 
 |     } | 
 |   catch (gdb_exception_error &e) | 
 |     { | 
 |       int not_found_and_ok = false; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will | 
 | 	 fail until the right shared library is loaded.  User has | 
 | 	 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need | 
 | 	 extra messages.  If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled | 
 | 	 state, then user already saw the message about that | 
 | 	 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more | 
 | 	 errors.  */ | 
 |       if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR | 
 | 	  && (condition_not_parsed | 
 | 	      || (this->has_locations () | 
 | 		  && search_pspace != NULL | 
 | 		  && this->first_loc ().pspace != search_pspace) | 
 | 	      || (this->has_locations () && this->first_loc ().shlib_disabled) | 
 | 	      || (this->has_locations () | 
 | 		  && this->first_loc ().pspace->executing_startup) | 
 | 	      || enable_state == bp_disabled)) | 
 | 	not_found_and_ok = true; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (!not_found_and_ok) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint | 
 | 	     10 times.  One solution, implemented here, is disable | 
 | 	     the breakpoint on error.  Another solution would be to | 
 | 	     have separate 'warning emitted' flag.  Since this | 
 | 	     happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know | 
 | 	     which approach is better.  */ | 
 | 	  enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
 | 	  throw; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       exception = std::move (e); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR) | 
 |     { | 
 |       for (auto &sal : sals) | 
 | 	resolve_sal_pc (&sal); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (type == bp_static_tracepoint) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  tracepoint *t = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (this); | 
 | 	  sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (t, sals[0]); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       *found = 1; | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     *found = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   return sals; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software | 
 |    breakpoints.  Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its | 
 |    locations.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | code_breakpoint::re_set_default (struct program_space *filter_pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   std::vector<symtab_and_line> expanded, expanded_end; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If this breakpoint is thread- or inferior-specific, then find the | 
 |      program space in which this breakpoint exists.  Otherwise, for | 
 |      breakpoints that are not thread- or inferior-specific, BP_PSPACE will | 
 |      be nullptr.  */ | 
 |   program_space *bp_pspace | 
 |     = find_program_space_for_breakpoint (this->thread, this->inferior); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If this is not a thread or inferior specific breakpoint, or it is a | 
 |      thread or inferior specific breakpoint but we are looking for new | 
 |      locations in the program space that the specific thread or inferior is | 
 |      running, then look for new locations for this breakpoint.  */ | 
 |   if (bp_pspace == nullptr || filter_pspace == bp_pspace) | 
 |     { | 
 |       int found; | 
 |       std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals | 
 | 	= location_spec_to_sals (locspec.get (), filter_pspace, &found); | 
 |       if (found) | 
 | 	expanded = std::move (sals); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (locspec_range_end != nullptr) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals_end | 
 | 	    = location_spec_to_sals (locspec_range_end.get (), | 
 | 				     filter_pspace, &found); | 
 | 	  if (found) | 
 | 	    expanded_end = std::move (sals_end); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Update the locations for this breakpoint.  For thread-specific | 
 |      breakpoints this will remove any old locations that are for the wrong | 
 |      program space -- this can happen if the user changes the thread of a | 
 |      thread-specific breakpoint.  */ | 
 |   update_breakpoint_locations (this, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space. | 
 |    Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint_re_set (void) | 
 | { | 
 |   { | 
 |     scoped_restore_current_language save_language; | 
 |     scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix); | 
 |     scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | 
 |  | 
 |     /* To ::re_set each breakpoint we set the current_language to the | 
 |        language of the breakpoint before re-evaluating the breakpoint's | 
 |        location.  This change can unfortunately get undone by accident if | 
 |        the language_mode is set to auto, and we either switch frames, or | 
 |        more likely in this context, we select the current frame. | 
 |  | 
 |        We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to | 
 |        language_mode_manual.  We restore it once all breakpoints | 
 |        have been reset.  */ | 
 |     scoped_restore save_language_mode = make_scoped_restore (&language_mode); | 
 |     language_mode = language_mode_manual; | 
 |  | 
 |     /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all | 
 |        breakpoints have been re-set.  Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting | 
 |        breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which | 
 |        hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |     for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	try | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    input_radix = b.input_radix; | 
 | 	    set_language (b.language); | 
 | 	    b.re_set (current_program_space); | 
 | 	  } | 
 | 	catch (const gdb_exception &ex) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex, | 
 | 			       "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ", | 
 | 			       b.number); | 
 | 	  } | 
 |       } | 
 |  | 
 |     jit_breakpoint_re_set (); | 
 |   } | 
 |  | 
 |   create_overlay_event_breakpoint (); | 
 |   create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (); | 
 |   create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (); | 
 |   create_exception_master_breakpoint (); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Now we can insert.  */ | 
 |   update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Re-set locations for breakpoint B in FILTER_PSPACE.  If FILTER_PSPACE is | 
 |    nullptr then re-set locations for B in all program spaces.  Locations | 
 |    bound to program spaces other than FILTER_PSPACE are left untouched.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b, program_space *filter_pspace) | 
 | { | 
 |   { | 
 |     scoped_restore_current_language save_language; | 
 |     scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix); | 
 |     scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | 
 |  | 
 |     /* To ::re_set each breakpoint we set the current_language to the | 
 |        language of the breakpoint before re-evaluating the breakpoint's | 
 |        location.  This change can unfortunately get undone by accident if | 
 |        the language_mode is set to auto, and we either switch frames, or | 
 |        more likely in this context, we select the current frame. | 
 |  | 
 |        We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to | 
 |        language_mode_manual.  We restore it once all breakpoints | 
 |        have been reset.  */ | 
 |     scoped_restore save_language_mode = make_scoped_restore (&language_mode); | 
 |     language_mode = language_mode_manual; | 
 |  | 
 |     /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all | 
 |        breakpoints have been re-set.  Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting | 
 |        breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which | 
 |        hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |     try | 
 |       { | 
 | 	input_radix = b->input_radix; | 
 | 	set_language (b->language); | 
 | 	b->re_set (filter_pspace); | 
 |       } | 
 |     catch (const gdb_exception &ex) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex, | 
 | 			   "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ", | 
 | 			   b->number); | 
 |       } | 
 |   } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Now we can insert.  */ | 
 |   update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint: | 
 |  | 
 |    - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is. | 
 |    - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid.  */ | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (b->thread != -1) | 
 |     { | 
 |       b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* We're being called after following a fork.  The new fork is | 
 | 	 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a | 
 | 	 different program space from the original thread.  Reset that | 
 | 	 as well.  */ | 
 |       b->first_loc ().pspace = current_program_space; | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT. | 
 |    If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect, | 
 |    which ends with a period (no newline).  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (count < 0) | 
 |     count = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (b.number == bptnum) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	if (is_tracepoint (&b)) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    if (from_tty && count != 0) | 
 | 	      gdb_printf (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."), | 
 | 			  bptnum); | 
 | 	    return; | 
 | 	  } | 
 |  | 
 | 	b.ignore_count = count; | 
 | 	if (from_tty) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    if (count == 0) | 
 | 	      gdb_printf (_("Will stop next time " | 
 | 			    "breakpoint %d is reached."), | 
 | 			  bptnum); | 
 | 	    else if (count == 1) | 
 | 	      gdb_printf (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."), | 
 | 			  bptnum); | 
 | 	    else | 
 | 	      gdb_printf (_("Will ignore next %d " | 
 | 			    "crossings of breakpoint %d."), | 
 | 			  count, bptnum); | 
 | 	  } | 
 | 	notify_breakpoint_modified (&b); | 
 | 	return; | 
 |       } | 
 |  | 
 |   error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | ignore_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   const char *p = args; | 
 |   int num; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (p == 0) | 
 |     error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number")); | 
 |  | 
 |   num = get_number (&p); | 
 |   if (num == 0) | 
 |     error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args); | 
 |   if (*p == 0) | 
 |     error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   set_ignore_count (num, | 
 | 		    longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))), | 
 | 		    from_tty); | 
 |   if (from_tty) | 
 |     gdb_printf ("\n"); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 | /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range | 
 |    defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range).  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, | 
 | 			     gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (bp_num_range.first == 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"), | 
 | 	       bp_num_range.first); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       for (int i = bp_num_range.first; i <= bp_num_range.second; i++) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  bool match = false; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 | 	    if (b.number == i) | 
 | 	      { | 
 | 		match = true; | 
 | 		function (&b); | 
 | 		break; | 
 | 	      } | 
 | 	  if (!match) | 
 | 	    gdb_printf (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in | 
 |    ARGS.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args, | 
 | 			gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (args == NULL || *args == '\0') | 
 |     error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers")); | 
 |  | 
 |   number_or_range_parser parser (args); | 
 |  | 
 |   while (!parser.finished ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       int num = parser.get_number (); | 
 |       map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num, num), function); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the | 
 |    BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static struct bp_location * | 
 | find_location_by_number (int bp_num, int loc_num) | 
 | { | 
 |   breakpoint *b = get_breakpoint (bp_num); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!b || b->number != bp_num) | 
 |     error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num); | 
 |    | 
 |   if (loc_num == 0) | 
 |     error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num); | 
 |  | 
 |   int n = 0; | 
 |   for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | 
 |     if (++n == loc_num) | 
 |       return &loc; | 
 |  | 
 |   error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num.  */ | 
 | enum class extract_bp_kind | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Extracting a breakpoint number.  */ | 
 |   bp, | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Extracting a location number.  */ | 
 |   loc, | 
 | }; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND) | 
 |    from the string starting at START.  TRAILER is a character which | 
 |    can be found after the number.  If you don't want a trailer, use | 
 |    '\0'.  If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed | 
 |    string.  This always returns a positive integer.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static int | 
 | extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind, const char *start, | 
 | 		int trailer, const char **end_out = NULL) | 
 | { | 
 |   const char *end = start; | 
 |   int num = get_number_trailer (&end, trailer); | 
 |   if (num < 0) | 
 |     error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp | 
 | 	   ? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'") | 
 | 	   : _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"), | 
 | 	   int (end - start), start); | 
 |   if (num == 0) | 
 |     error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp | 
 | 	   ? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'") | 
 | 	   : _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"), | 
 | 	   int (end - start), start); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (end_out != NULL) | 
 |     *end_out = end; | 
 |   return num; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in | 
 |    the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset].  Returns a std::pair | 
 |    representing the (inclusive) range.  The returned pair's elements | 
 |    are always positive integers.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static std::pair<int, int> | 
 | extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind, | 
 | 			const std::string &arg, | 
 | 			std::string::size_type arg_offset) | 
 | { | 
 |   std::pair<int, int> range; | 
 |   const char *bp_loc = &arg[arg_offset]; | 
 |   std::string::size_type dash = arg.find ('-', arg_offset); | 
 |   if (dash != std::string::npos) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* bp_loc is a range (x-z).  */ | 
 |       if (arg.length () == dash + 1) | 
 | 	error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp | 
 | 	       ? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'") | 
 | 	       : _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"), | 
 | 	       bp_loc); | 
 |  | 
 |       const char *end; | 
 |       const char *start_first = bp_loc; | 
 |       const char *start_second = &arg[dash + 1]; | 
 |       range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, start_first, '-'); | 
 |       range.second = extract_bp_num (kind, start_second, '\0', &end); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (range.first > range.second) | 
 | 	error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp | 
 | 	       ? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'") | 
 | 	       : _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"), | 
 | 	       int (end - start_first), start_first); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* bp_loc is a single value.  */ | 
 |       range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, bp_loc, '\0'); | 
 |       range.second = range.first; | 
 |     } | 
 |   return range; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG.  Returns | 
 |    the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in | 
 |    BP_LOC_RANGE. | 
 |  | 
 |    ARG may be in any of the following forms: | 
 |  | 
 |    x     where 'x' is a breakpoint number. | 
 |    x-y   where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range. | 
 |    x.y   where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number. | 
 |    x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a | 
 | 	 location number range. | 
 | */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string &arg, | 
 | 				std::pair<int, int> &bp_num_range, | 
 | 				std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range) | 
 | { | 
 |   std::string::size_type dot = arg.find ('.'); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (dot != std::string::npos) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |       if (arg.length () == dot + 1 || dot == 0) | 
 | 	error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg.c_str ()); | 
 |  | 
 |       bp_num_range.first | 
 | 	= extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg.c_str (), '.'); | 
 |       bp_num_range.second = bp_num_range.first; | 
 |  | 
 |       bp_loc_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc, | 
 | 					     arg, dot + 1); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Handle x and x-y cases.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |       bp_num_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg, 0); | 
 |       bp_loc_range.first = 0; | 
 |       bp_loc_range.second = 0; | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM.  ENABLE | 
 |    specifies whether to enable or disable.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num, int loc_num, bool enable) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (bp_num, loc_num); | 
 |   if (loc != NULL) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (loc->disabled_by_cond && enable) | 
 | 	error (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is invalid at location %d, " | 
 | 		 "cannot enable."), bp_num, loc_num); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (loc->enabled != enable) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  loc->enabled = enable; | 
 | 	  mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint () | 
 | 	  && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner | 
 | 	  && is_tracepoint (loc->owner)) | 
 | 	target_disable_tracepoint (loc); | 
 |     } | 
 |   update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
 |  | 
 |   notify_breakpoint_modified (loc->owner); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Calculates LOC_NUM for LOC by traversing the bp_location chain of LOC's | 
 |    owner.  1-based indexing.  -1 signals NOT FOUND.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static int | 
 | find_loc_num_by_location (const bp_location *loc) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (loc != nullptr && loc->owner != nullptr) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Locations use 1-based indexing.  */ | 
 |       int loc_num = 1; | 
 |       for (bp_location &it : loc->owner->locations ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (&it == loc) | 
 | 	    return loc_num; | 
 | 	  loc_num++; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |   return -1; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location LOC.  ENABLE | 
 |    specifies whether to enable or disable.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | enable_disable_bp_location (bp_location *loc, bool enable) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (loc == nullptr) | 
 |     error (_("Breakpoint location is invalid.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (loc->owner == nullptr) | 
 |     error (_("Breakpoint location does not have an owner breakpoint.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (loc->disabled_by_cond && enable) | 
 |     { | 
 |       int loc_num = find_loc_num_by_location (loc); | 
 |       if (loc_num == -1) | 
 | 	error (_("Breakpoint location LOC_NUM could not be found.")); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	error (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is invalid at location %d, " | 
 | 		 "cannot enable."), loc->owner->number, loc_num); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (loc->enabled != enable) | 
 |     { | 
 |       loc->enabled = enable; | 
 |       mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint () | 
 |       && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner | 
 |       && is_tracepoint (loc->owner)) | 
 |     target_disable_tracepoint (loc); | 
 |  | 
 |   update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
 |   notify_breakpoint_modified (loc->owner); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations.  BP_NUM is the | 
 |    number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the | 
 |    (inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to | 
 |    enable/disable.  ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the | 
 |    location.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num, | 
 | 					  std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range, | 
 | 					  bool enable) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (int i = bp_loc_range.first; i <= bp_loc_range.second; i++) | 
 |     enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num, i, enable); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT. | 
 |    If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect, | 
 |    which ends with a period (no newline).  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to | 
 |      hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the | 
 |      watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time.  */ | 
 |   if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope) | 
 |     return; | 
 |  | 
 |   bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Mark breakpoint locations modified.  */ | 
 |   mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint () | 
 |       && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       for (bp_location &location : bpt->locations ()) | 
 | 	target_disable_tracepoint (&location); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
 |  | 
 |   notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s) | 
 |    specified in ARGS.  ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by | 
 |    extract_bp_number_and_location.  ENABLE specifies whether to enable | 
 |    or disable the breakpoints/locations.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | enable_disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty, bool enable) | 
 | { | 
 |   if (args == 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       for (breakpoint &bpt : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 | 	if (user_breakpoint_p (&bpt)) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    if (enable) | 
 | 	      enable_breakpoint (&bpt); | 
 | 	    else | 
 | 	      disable_breakpoint (&bpt); | 
 | 	  } | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       std::string num = extract_arg (&args); | 
 |  | 
 |       while (!num.empty ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, bp_loc_range; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  extract_bp_number_and_location (num, bp_num_range, bp_loc_range); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  if (bp_loc_range.first == bp_loc_range.second | 
 | 	      && (bp_loc_range.first == 0 | 
 | 		  || (bp_loc_range.first == 1 | 
 | 		      && bp_num_range.first == bp_num_range.second | 
 | 		      && !has_multiple_locations (bp_num_range.first)))) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z' | 
 | 		 or 'y.1' where y has only one code location.  */ | 
 | 	      map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range, | 
 | 					   enable | 
 | 					   ? enable_breakpoint | 
 | 					   : disable_breakpoint); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  else | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or | 
 | 		 'x.y-z'.  */ | 
 | 	      enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range | 
 | 		(bp_num_range.first, bp_loc_range, enable); | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	  num = extract_arg (&args); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations | 
 |    (or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in | 
 |    stopping the inferior.  ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in | 
 |    extract_bp_number_and_location.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, false); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition, | 
 | 			int count) | 
 | { | 
 |   int target_resources_ok; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) | 
 |     { | 
 |       int i; | 
 |       i = hw_breakpoint_used_count (); | 
 |       target_resources_ok =  | 
 | 	target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,  | 
 | 					    i + 1, 0); | 
 |       if (target_resources_ok == 0) | 
 | 	error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target.")); | 
 |       else if (target_resources_ok < 0) | 
 | 	error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit.")); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (is_watchpoint (bpt)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning.  */ | 
 |       enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
 |  | 
 |       try | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  watchpoint *w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (bpt); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state; | 
 | 	  bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
 | 	  update_watchpoint (w, true /* reparse */); | 
 | 	} | 
 |       catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state; | 
 | 	  exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "), | 
 | 			     bpt->number); | 
 | 	  return; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Mark breakpoint locations modified.  */ | 
 |   mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint () | 
 |       && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt)) | 
 |     { | 
 |       for (bp_location &location : bpt->locations ()) | 
 | 	target_enable_tracepoint (&location); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   bpt->disposition = disposition; | 
 |   bpt->enable_count = count; | 
 |   update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
 |  | 
 |   notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
 | { | 
 |   enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or | 
 |    all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to | 
 |    be) effective in stopping the inferior.  ARGS may be in any of the | 
 |    forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | enable_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, true); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | enable_once_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   map_breakpoint_numbers | 
 |     (args, [&] (breakpoint *b) | 
 |      { | 
 |        iterate_over_related_breakpoints | 
 | 	 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, 1); | 
 | 	  }); | 
 |      }); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | enable_count_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   int count; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (args == NULL) | 
 |     error_no_arg (_("hit count")); | 
 |  | 
 |   count = get_number (&args); | 
 |  | 
 |   map_breakpoint_numbers | 
 |     (args, [&] (breakpoint *b) | 
 |      { | 
 |        iterate_over_related_breakpoints | 
 | 	 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, count); | 
 | 	  }); | 
 |      }); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | enable_delete_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   map_breakpoint_numbers | 
 |     (args, [&] (breakpoint *b) | 
 |      { | 
 |        iterate_over_related_breakpoints | 
 | 	 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_del, 1); | 
 | 	  }); | 
 |      }); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if | 
 |    the memory which that value represents has been written to by | 
 |    GDB itself.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior, | 
 | 				      CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len, | 
 | 				      const bfd_byte *data) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &bp : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     if (bp.enable_state == bp_enabled | 
 | 	&& bp.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint) | 
 |       { | 
 | 	watchpoint &wp = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint &> (bp); | 
 |  | 
 | 	if (wp.val_valid && wp.val != nullptr) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    for (bp_location &loc : bp.locations ()) | 
 | 	      if (loc.loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint | 
 | 		  && loc.address + loc.length > addr | 
 | 		  && addr + len > loc.address) | 
 | 		{ | 
 | 		  wp.val = NULL; | 
 | 		  wp.val_valid = false; | 
 | 		} | 
 | 	  } | 
 |       } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
 | 			       const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 			       CORE_ADDR next_pc) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread (); | 
 |   struct symtab_and_line sal; | 
 |   CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL) | 
 |     { | 
 |       std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b | 
 | 	(new momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_single_step, | 
 | 				   current_program_space, | 
 | 				   null_frame_id, | 
 | 				   tp->global_num)); | 
 |  | 
 |       tp->control.single_step_breakpoints | 
 | 	= add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b)); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0); | 
 |   sal.pc = pc; | 
 |   sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc); | 
 |   sal.explicit_pc = 1; | 
 |  | 
 |   auto *ss_bp | 
 |     = (gdb::checked_static_cast<momentary_breakpoint *> | 
 |        (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints)); | 
 |   ss_bp->add_location (sal); | 
 |  | 
 |   update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch) | 
 | { | 
 |   regcache *regcache = get_thread_regcache (inferior_thread ()); | 
 |   std::vector<CORE_ADDR> next_pcs = gdbarch_get_next_pcs (gdbarch, regcache); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!next_pcs.empty ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       frame_info_ptr frame = get_current_frame (); | 
 |       const address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame); | 
 |  | 
 |       for (CORE_ADDR pc : next_pcs) | 
 | 	insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc); | 
 |  | 
 |       return 1; | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp, | 
 | 				       const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 				       CORE_ADDR pc) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (bp_location &loc : bp->locations ()) | 
 |     if (loc.inserted | 
 | 	&& breakpoint_location_address_match (&loc, aspace, pc)) | 
 |       return 1; | 
 |  | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at | 
 |    PC.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, | 
 | 					CORE_ADDR pc) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &bpt : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (bpt.type == bp_single_step | 
 | 	  && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (&bpt, aspace, pc)) | 
 | 	return 1; | 
 |     } | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Tracepoint-specific operations.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | /* Set tracepoint count to NUM.  */ | 
 | static void | 
 | set_tracepoint_count (int num) | 
 | { | 
 |   tracepoint_count = num; | 
 |   set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   location_spec_up locspec = string_to_location_spec (&arg, | 
 | 						      current_language); | 
 |   const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = breakpoint_ops_for_location_spec | 
 |     (locspec.get (), true /* is_tracepoint */); | 
 |  | 
 |   create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | 
 | 		     locspec.get (), | 
 | 		     NULL, -1, -1, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */, | 
 | 		     0 /* tempflag */, | 
 | 		     bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */, | 
 | 		     0 /* Ignore count */, | 
 | 		     pending_break_support, | 
 | 		     ops, | 
 | 		     from_tty, | 
 | 		     1 /* enabled */, | 
 | 		     0 /* internal */, 0); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | ftrace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   location_spec_up locspec = string_to_location_spec (&arg, | 
 | 						      current_language); | 
 |   create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | 
 | 		     locspec.get (), | 
 | 		     NULL, -1, -1, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */, | 
 | 		     0 /* tempflag */, | 
 | 		     bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */, | 
 | 		     0 /* Ignore count */, | 
 | 		     pending_break_support, | 
 | 		     &code_breakpoint_ops, | 
 | 		     from_tty, | 
 | 		     1 /* enabled */, | 
 | 		     0 /* internal */, 0); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* strace command implementation.  Creates a static tracepoint.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | strace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   const struct breakpoint_ops *ops; | 
 |   location_spec_up locspec; | 
 |   enum bptype type; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'), | 
 |      or with a normal static tracepoint.  */ | 
 |   if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && c_isspace (arg[2])) | 
 |     { | 
 |       ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops; | 
 |       locspec = new_linespec_location_spec (&arg, | 
 | 					    symbol_name_match_type::FULL); | 
 |       type = bp_static_marker_tracepoint; | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       ops = &code_breakpoint_ops; | 
 |       locspec = string_to_location_spec (&arg, current_language); | 
 |       type = bp_static_tracepoint; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | 
 | 		     locspec.get (), | 
 | 		     NULL, -1, -1, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */, | 
 | 		     0 /* tempflag */, | 
 | 		     type /* type_wanted */, | 
 | 		     0 /* Ignore count */, | 
 | 		     pending_break_support, | 
 | 		     ops, | 
 | 		     from_tty, | 
 | 		     1 /* enabled */, | 
 | 		     0 /* internal */, 0); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked | 
 |    list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp; | 
 | static int next_cmd; | 
 |  | 
 | static const char * | 
 | read_uploaded_action (std::string &buffer) | 
 | { | 
 |   char *rslt = nullptr; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (next_cmd < this_utp->cmd_strings.size ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       rslt = this_utp->cmd_strings[next_cmd].get (); | 
 |       next_cmd++; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return rslt; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which | 
 |    can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an | 
 |    equivalent GDB tracepoint.  This is not a reliable process, since | 
 |    the target does not necessarily have all the information used when | 
 |    the tracepoint was originally defined.  */ | 
 |    | 
 | struct tracepoint * | 
 | create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp) | 
 | { | 
 |   const char *addr_str; | 
 |   char small_buf[100]; | 
 |   struct tracepoint *tp; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (utp->at_string) | 
 |     addr_str = utp->at_string.get (); | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw | 
 | 	 address.  Since there is no way to confirm that the address | 
 | 	 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the | 
 | 	 user.  */ | 
 |       warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no " | 
 | 		 "source location, using raw address"), | 
 | 	       utp->number); | 
 |       xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr)); | 
 |       addr_str = small_buf; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes.  */ | 
 |   if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string) | 
 |     warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition " | 
 | 	       "has no source form, ignoring it"), | 
 | 	     utp->number); | 
 |  | 
 |   location_spec_up locspec = string_to_location_spec (&addr_str, | 
 | 						      current_language); | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_assert (addr_str != nullptr); | 
 |   if (*addr_str != '\0') | 
 |     error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), addr_str); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | 
 | 			  locspec.get (), | 
 | 			  utp->cond_string.get (), -1, -1, addr_str, | 
 | 			  false /* force_condition */, | 
 | 			  0 /* parse cond/thread */, | 
 | 			  0 /* tempflag */, | 
 | 			  utp->type /* type_wanted */, | 
 | 			  0 /* Ignore count */, | 
 | 			  pending_break_support, | 
 | 			  &code_breakpoint_ops, | 
 | 			  0 /* from_tty */, | 
 | 			  utp->enabled /* enabled */, | 
 | 			  0 /* internal */, | 
 | 			  CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED)) | 
 |     return NULL; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Get the tracepoint we just created.  */ | 
 |   tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count); | 
 |   gdb_assert (tp != NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (utp->pass > 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass, | 
 | 		 tp->number); | 
 |  | 
 |       trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a | 
 |      special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line | 
 |      reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting | 
 |      function.  */ | 
 |   if (!utp->cmd_strings.empty ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       counted_command_line cmd_list; | 
 |  | 
 |       this_utp = utp; | 
 |       next_cmd = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |       cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL); | 
 |  | 
 |       breakpoint_set_commands (tp, std::move (cmd_list)); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else if (!utp->actions.empty () | 
 | 	   || !utp->step_actions.empty ()) | 
 |     warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions " | 
 | 	       "have no source form, ignoring them"), | 
 | 	     utp->number); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Copy any status information that might be available.  */ | 
 |   tp->hit_count = utp->hit_count; | 
 |   tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage; | 
 |  | 
 |   return tp; | 
 | } | 
 |    | 
 | /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if | 
 |    omitted.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | info_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
 |   int num_printed; | 
 |  | 
 |   num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_tracepoint); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (num_printed == 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (args == NULL || *args == '\0') | 
 | 	uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n"); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   default_collect_info (); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints. | 
 |    Not supported by all targets.  */ | 
 | static void | 
 | enable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   enable_command (args, from_tty); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints. | 
 |    Not supported by all targets.  */ | 
 | static void | 
 | disable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   disable_command (args, from_tty); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument).  */ | 
 | static void | 
 | delete_trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   dont_repeat (); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (arg == 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       int breaks_to_delete = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Delete all tracepoints if no argument. | 
 | 	 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these | 
 | 	 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number  | 
 | 	 argument.  */ | 
 |       for (breakpoint &tp : all_tracepoints ()) | 
 | 	if (is_tracepoint (&tp) && user_breakpoint_p (&tp)) | 
 | 	  { | 
 | 	    breaks_to_delete = 1; | 
 | 	    break; | 
 | 	  } | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete.  */ | 
 |       if (!from_tty | 
 | 	  || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? ")))) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | 
 | 	    if (is_tracepoint (&b) && user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | 
 | 	      delete_breakpoint (&b); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     map_breakpoint_numbers | 
 |       (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br) | 
 |        { | 
 | 	 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint); | 
 |        }); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Helper function for trace_pass_command.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   tp->pass_count = count; | 
 |   notify_breakpoint_modified (tp); | 
 |   if (from_tty) | 
 |     gdb_printf (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"), | 
 | 		tp->number, count); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Set passcount for tracepoint. | 
 |  | 
 |    First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number. | 
 |    If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined. | 
 |    Also accepts special argument "all".  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | trace_pass_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   ULONGEST count; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (args == 0 || *args == 0) | 
 |     error (_("passcount command requires an " | 
 | 	     "argument (count + optional TP num)")); | 
 |  | 
 |   count = strtoulst (args, &args, 10);	/* Count comes first, then TP num.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   args = skip_spaces (args); | 
 |   if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       args += 3;			/* Skip special argument "all".  */ | 
 |       if (*args) | 
 | 	error (_("Junk at end of arguments.")); | 
 |  | 
 |       for (breakpoint &b : all_tracepoints ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  tracepoint &t1 = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint &> (b); | 
 | 	  trace_pass_set_count (&t1, count, from_tty); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |   else if (*args == '\0') | 
 |     { | 
 |       tracepoint *t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL); | 
 |       if (t1) | 
 | 	trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else | 
 |     { | 
 |       number_or_range_parser parser (args); | 
 |       while (!parser.finished ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  tracepoint *t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser); | 
 | 	  if (t1) | 
 | 	    trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty); | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | struct tracepoint * | 
 | get_tracepoint (int num) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &t : all_tracepoints ()) | 
 |     if (t.number == num) | 
 |       return gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (&t); | 
 |  | 
 |   return NULL; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be | 
 |    different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and | 
 |    reconnecting).  */ | 
 |  | 
 | struct tracepoint * | 
 | get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_tracepoints ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       tracepoint &t = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint &> (b); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (t.number_on_target == num) | 
 | 	return &t; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return NULL; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list. | 
 |    If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG. | 
 |    If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint | 
 |    (tracepoint_count) is returned.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | struct tracepoint * | 
 | get_tracepoint_by_number (const char **arg, | 
 | 			  number_or_range_parser *parser) | 
 | { | 
 |   int tpnum; | 
 |   const char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (parser != NULL) | 
 |     { | 
 |       gdb_assert (!parser->finished ()); | 
 |       tpnum = parser->get_number (); | 
 |     } | 
 |   else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg) | 
 |     tpnum = tracepoint_count; | 
 |   else | 
 |     tpnum = get_number (arg); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (tpnum <= 0) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (instring && *instring) | 
 | 	gdb_printf (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),  | 
 | 		    instring); | 
 |       else | 
 | 	gdb_printf (_("No previous tracepoint\n")); | 
 |       return NULL; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &t : all_tracepoints ()) | 
 |     if (t.number == tpnum) | 
 |       return gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (&t); | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_printf ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum); | 
 |   return NULL; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint::print_recreate_thread (struct ui_file *fp) const | 
 | { | 
 |   if (thread != -1) | 
 |     { | 
 |       struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (thread); | 
 |       gdb_printf (fp, " thread %s", print_full_thread_id (thr)); | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (task != -1) | 
 |     gdb_printf (fp, " task %d", task); | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb_printf (fp, "\n"); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to | 
 |    a new script file named FILENAME.  If FILTER is non-NULL, call it | 
 |    on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns | 
 |    true.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | save_breakpoints (const char *filename, int from_tty, | 
 | 		  bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *)) | 
 | { | 
 |   bool any = false; | 
 |   int extra_trace_bits = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0) | 
 |     error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)")); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* See if we have anything to save.  */ | 
 |   for (breakpoint &tp : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints.  */ | 
 |       if (!user_breakpoint_p (&tp)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts.  */ | 
 |       if (filter && !filter (&tp)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       any = true; | 
 |  | 
 |       if (is_tracepoint (&tp)) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  extra_trace_bits = 1; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  /* We can stop searching.  */ | 
 | 	  break; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!any) | 
 |     { | 
 |       warning (_("Nothing to save.")); | 
 |       return; | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename)); | 
 |  | 
 |   stdio_file fp; | 
 |  | 
 |   if (!fp.open (expanded_filename.get (), "w")) | 
 |     error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"), | 
 | 	   expanded_filename.get (), safe_strerror (errno)); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (extra_trace_bits) | 
 |     save_trace_state_variables (&fp); | 
 |  | 
 |   for (breakpoint &tp : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints.  */ | 
 |       if (!user_breakpoint_p (&tp)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts.  */ | 
 |       if (filter && !filter (&tp)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       tp.print_recreate (&fp); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't | 
 | 	 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match.  Use $bpnum | 
 | 	 instead.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |       if (tp.cond_string) | 
 | 	fp.printf ("  condition $bpnum %s\n", tp.cond_string.get ()); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (tp.ignore_count) | 
 | 	fp.printf ("  ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp.ignore_count); | 
 |  | 
 |       if (tp.type != bp_dprintf && tp.commands) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  fp.puts ("  commands\n"); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  ui_out_redirect_pop redir (current_uiout, &fp); | 
 | 	  print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp.commands.get (), 2); | 
 |  | 
 | 	  fp.puts ("  end\n"); | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (tp.enable_state == bp_disabled) | 
 | 	fp.puts ("disable $bpnum\n"); | 
 |  | 
 |       /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations | 
 | 	 should be individually disabled.  Watchpoint locations are | 
 | 	 special, and not user visible.  */ | 
 |       if (!is_watchpoint (&tp) && tp.has_multiple_locations ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  int n = 1; | 
 |  | 
 | 	  for (bp_location &loc : tp.locations ()) | 
 | 	    { | 
 | 	      if (!loc.enabled) | 
 | 		fp.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n); | 
 |  | 
 | 	      n++; | 
 | 	    } | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   if (extra_trace_bits && !default_collect.empty ()) | 
 |     fp.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect.c_str ()); | 
 |  | 
 |   if (from_tty) | 
 |     gdb_printf (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename.get ()); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* The `save breakpoints' command.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | save_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* The `save tracepoints' command.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static void | 
 | save_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | 
 | { | 
 |   save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 | /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying | 
 |    locations used by several commands.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | #define LOCATION_SPEC_HELP_STRING \ | 
 | "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\ | 
 | source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\ | 
 | Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\ | 
 | function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\ | 
 | \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\ | 
 | program.  Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\ | 
 | \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\ | 
 | syntax to specify location parameters.\n\ | 
 | Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\ | 
 | function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\ | 
 | -function fact -label the_top\".\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | By default, a specified function is matched against the program's\n\ | 
 | functions in all scopes.  For C++, this means in all namespaces and\n\ | 
 | classes.  For Ada, this means in all packages.  E.g., in C++,\n\ | 
 | \"func()\" matches \"A::func()\", \"A::B::func()\", etc.  The\n\ | 
 | \"-qualified\" flag overrides this behavior, making GDB interpret the\n\ | 
 | specified name as a complete fully-qualified name instead." | 
 |  | 
 | /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak | 
 |    commands.  It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication. | 
 |    COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the | 
 |    command.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \ | 
 | command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM]\n\ | 
 | \t[-force-condition] [if CONDITION]\n\ | 
 | PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\ | 
 | probe point.  Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\ | 
 | guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or\n\ | 
 | `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\ | 
 | LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\ | 
 | below.\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\ | 
 | stack frame.  This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\ | 
 | CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | With the \"-force-condition\" flag, the condition is defined even when\n\ | 
 | it is invalid for all current locations.\n\ | 
 | \n" LOCATION_SPEC_HELP_STRING "\n\n\ | 
 | Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\ | 
 | conditions are different.\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints." | 
 |  | 
 | /* List of subcommands for "catch".  */ | 
 | static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist; | 
 |  | 
 | /* List of subcommands for "tcatch".  */ | 
 | static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist; | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | add_catch_command (const char *name, const char *docstring, | 
 | 		   cmd_func_ftype *func, | 
 | 		   completer_ftype *completer, | 
 | 		   void *user_data_catch, | 
 | 		   void *user_data_tcatch) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct cmd_list_element *command; | 
 |  | 
 |   command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring, | 
 | 		     &catch_cmdlist); | 
 |   command->func = func; | 
 |   command->set_context (user_data_catch); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer (command, completer); | 
 |  | 
 |   command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring, | 
 | 		     &tcatch_cmdlist); | 
 |   command->func = func; | 
 |   command->set_context (user_data_tcatch); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer (command, completer); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* False if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where | 
 |    functions have been inlined, true otherwise.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static bool | 
 | is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b) | 
 | { | 
 |   /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a | 
 |      non-inline function.  */ | 
 |   return (b->type == bp_shlib_event); | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions | 
 |    have been inlined.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc, | 
 | 			   const target_waitstatus &ws) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (!is_non_inline_function (&b)) | 
 | 	continue; | 
 |  | 
 |       for (bp_location &bl : b.locations ()) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  if (!bl.shlib_disabled | 
 | 	      && bpstat_check_location (&bl, aspace, pc, ws)) | 
 | 	    return 1; | 
 | 	} | 
 |     } | 
 |  | 
 |   return 0; | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | void | 
 | breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile) | 
 | { | 
 |   for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) | 
 |     { | 
 |       if (loc->symtab != nullptr | 
 | 	  && loc->symtab->compunit ()->objfile () == objfile) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  loc->symtab = nullptr; | 
 | 	  loc->symbol = nullptr; | 
 | 	  loc->msymbol = nullptr; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (loc->section != nullptr | 
 | 	  && loc->section->objfile == objfile) | 
 | 	{ | 
 | 	  /* If symtab was set then it should have already been cleared. | 
 | 	     But if bp_location::msymbol was set then the symbol and symtab | 
 | 	     might already have been nullptr.  */ | 
 | 	  gdb_assert (loc->symtab == nullptr); | 
 | 	  loc->section = nullptr; | 
 | 	  loc->symbol = nullptr; | 
 | 	  loc->msymbol = nullptr; | 
 | 	} | 
 |  | 
 |       if (loc->probe.objfile == objfile) | 
 | 	loc->probe = bound_probe (); | 
 |     } | 
 | } | 
 |  | 
 | /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL; | 
 |  | 
 | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
 |  | 
 | cmd_list_element *commands_cmd_element = nullptr; | 
 |  | 
 | INIT_GDB_FILE (breakpoint) | 
 | { | 
 |   struct cmd_list_element *c; | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb::observers::solib_unloaded.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, | 
 | 					 "breakpoint"); | 
 |   gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile, | 
 | 				       "breakpoint"); | 
 |   gdb::observers::memory_changed.attach (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change, | 
 | 					 "breakpoint"); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count.  $bpnum isn't useful | 
 |      before a breakpoint is set.  */ | 
 |   breakpoint_count = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   tracepoint_count = 0; | 
 |  | 
 |   add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\ | 
 | Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\ | 
 | Usage is `ignore N COUNT'.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   commands_cmd_element = add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, | 
 | 				  commands_command, _("\ | 
 | Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\ | 
 | Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\ | 
 | A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\ | 
 | (e.g. `5-7').\n\ | 
 | With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\ | 
 | The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\ | 
 | Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\ | 
 | Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\ | 
 | then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   const auto cc_opts = make_condition_command_options_def_group (nullptr); | 
 |   static std::string condition_command_help | 
 |     = gdb::option::build_help (_("\ | 
 | Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\ | 
 | Usage is `condition [OPTION] N COND', where N is an integer and COND\n\ | 
 | is an expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached.\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | Options:\n\ | 
 | %OPTIONS%"), cc_opts); | 
 |  | 
 |   c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, | 
 | 	       condition_command_help.c_str ()); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, condition_completer); | 
 |  | 
 |   c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\ | 
 | Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\ | 
 | Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\ | 
 | so it will be deleted when hit.  Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\ | 
 | by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\ | 
 | \n" | 
 | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak"))); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | 
 |  | 
 |   c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\ | 
 | Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\ | 
 | Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\ | 
 | some target hardware may not have this support.\n\ | 
 | \n" | 
 | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak"))); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | 
 |  | 
 |   c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\ | 
 | Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\ | 
 | Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\ | 
 | so it will be deleted when hit.\n\ | 
 | \n" | 
 | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak"))); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | 
 |  | 
 |   cmd_list_element *enable_cmd | 
 |     = add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\ | 
 | Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\ | 
 | Usage: enable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ | 
 | Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\ | 
 | With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\ | 
 | This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\ | 
 | With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."), | 
 | 		      &enablelist, 1, &cmdlist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_com_alias ("en", enable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\ | 
 | Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\ | 
 | Usage: enable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ | 
 | Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\ | 
 | This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\ | 
 | May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\"."), | 
 | 		   &enablebreaklist, 1, &enablelist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\ | 
 | Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\ | 
 | Usage: enable breakpoints once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ | 
 | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."), | 
 | 	   &enablebreaklist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\ | 
 | Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\ | 
 | Usage: enable breakpoints delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ | 
 | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."), | 
 | 	   &enablebreaklist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\ | 
 | Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\ | 
 | Usage: enable breakpoints count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ | 
 | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\ | 
 | the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."), | 
 | 	   &enablebreaklist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\ | 
 | Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\ | 
 | Usage: enable delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ | 
 | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."), | 
 | 	   &enablelist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\ | 
 | Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\ | 
 | Usage: enable once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ | 
 | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."), | 
 | 	   &enablelist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\ | 
 | Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\ | 
 | Usage: enable count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ | 
 | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\ | 
 | the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."), | 
 | 	   &enablelist); | 
 |  | 
 |   cmd_list_element *disable_cmd | 
 |     = add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\ | 
 | Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\ | 
 | Usage: disable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ | 
 | Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ | 
 | To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\ | 
 | A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."), | 
 | 		      &disablelist, 1, &cmdlist); | 
 |   add_com_alias ("dis", disable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | 
 |   add_com_alias ("disa", disable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\ | 
 | Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\ | 
 | Usage: disable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ | 
 | Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ | 
 | To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\ | 
 | A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\ | 
 | This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."), | 
 | 	   &disablelist); | 
 |  | 
 |   cmd_list_element *delete_cmd | 
 |     = add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\ | 
 | Delete all or some breakpoints.\n\ | 
 | Usage: delete [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ | 
 | Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ | 
 | To delete all breakpoints, watchpoints, tracepoints, and catchpoints,\n\ | 
 | give no argument.\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects."), | 
 | 		      &deletelist, 1, &cmdlist); | 
 |   add_com_alias ("d", delete_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | 
 |   add_com_alias ("del", delete_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\ | 
 | Delete all or some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\ | 
 | Usage: delete breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ | 
 | Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ | 
 | To delete all breakpoints, watchpoints, tracepoints, and catchpoints,\n\ | 
 | give no argument.\n\ | 
 | This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."), | 
 | 	   &deletelist); | 
 |  | 
 |   cmd_list_element *clear_cmd | 
 |    = add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\ | 
 | Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\ | 
 | Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\ | 
 | is executing in.\n" | 
 | "\n" LOCATION_SPEC_HELP_STRING "\n\n\ | 
 | See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number.")); | 
 |   add_com_alias ("cl", clear_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | 
 |  | 
 |   cmd_list_element *break_cmd | 
 |     = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\ | 
 | Set breakpoint at specified location.\n" | 
 | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break"))); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer (break_cmd, location_completer); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_com_alias ("b", break_cmd, class_run, 1); | 
 |   add_com_alias ("br", break_cmd, class_run, 1); | 
 |   add_com_alias ("bre", break_cmd, class_run, 1); | 
 |   add_com_alias ("brea", break_cmd, class_run, 1); | 
 |  | 
 |   cmd_list_element *info_breakpoints_cmd | 
 |     = add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command, _("\ | 
 | Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\ | 
 | The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\ | 
 | \tbreakpoint     - normal breakpoint\n\ | 
 | \twatchpoint     - watchpoint\n\ | 
 | The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\ | 
 | the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit.  \"dis\" means that the\n\ | 
 | breakpoint will be disabled.  The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\ | 
 | address and file/line number respectively.\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\ | 
 | are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\ | 
 | is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\ | 
 | Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\ | 
 | breakpoint set.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_info_alias ("b", info_breakpoints_cmd, 1); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\ | 
 | Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\ | 
 | The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\ | 
 | \tbreakpoint     - normal breakpoint\n\ | 
 | \twatchpoint     - watchpoint\n\ | 
 | \tlongjmp        - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\ | 
 | \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\ | 
 | \tuntil          - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\ | 
 | \tfinish         - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\ | 
 | The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\ | 
 | the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit.  \"dis\" means that the\n\ | 
 | breakpoint will be disabled.  The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\ | 
 | address and file/line number respectively.\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\ | 
 | are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\ | 
 | is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\ | 
 | Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\ | 
 | breakpoint set."), | 
 | 	   &maintenanceinfolist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_basic_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, _("\ | 
 | Set catchpoints to catch events."), | 
 | 			&catch_cmdlist, | 
 | 			0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_basic_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, _("\ | 
 | Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."), | 
 | 			&tcatch_cmdlist, | 
 | 			0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist); | 
 |  | 
 |   const auto opts = make_watch_options_def_group (nullptr); | 
 |  | 
 |   static const std::string watch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\ | 
 | Set a watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\ | 
 | Usage: watch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | Options:\n\ | 
 | %OPTIONS%\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\ | 
 | an expression changes."), opts); | 
 |   c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, | 
 | 	       watch_help.c_str ()); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer); | 
 |  | 
 |   static const std::string rwatch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\ | 
 | Set a read watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\ | 
 | Usage: rwatch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | Options:\n\ | 
 | %OPTIONS%\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | A read watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\ | 
 | an expression is read."), opts); | 
 |   c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, | 
 | 	       rwatch_help.c_str ()); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer); | 
 |  | 
 |   static const std::string awatch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\ | 
 | Set an access watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\ | 
 | Usage: awatch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | Options:\n\ | 
 | %OPTIONS%\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | An access watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value\n\ | 
 | of an expression is either read or written."), opts); | 
 |   c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, | 
 | 	       awatch_help.c_str ()); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command, _("\ | 
 | Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument).")); | 
 |  | 
 |   /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should | 
 |      respond to changes - contrary to the description.  */ | 
 |   add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support, | 
 | 			    &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\ | 
 | Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\ | 
 | Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\ | 
 | If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\ | 
 | such is available.  (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\ | 
 | created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\ | 
 | hardware.)"), | 
 | 			    NULL, | 
 | 			    show_can_use_hw_watchpoints, | 
 | 			    &setlist, &showlist); | 
 |  | 
 |   can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1; | 
 |  | 
 |   /* Tracepoint manipulation commands.  */ | 
 |  | 
 |   cmd_list_element *trace_cmd | 
 |     = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\ | 
 | Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\ | 
 | \n" | 
 | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\ | 
 | Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands.")); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer (trace_cmd, location_completer); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_com_alias ("tp", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 0); | 
 |   add_com_alias ("tr", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | 
 |   add_com_alias ("tra", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | 
 |   add_com_alias ("trac", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | 
 |  | 
 |   c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\ | 
 | Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\ | 
 | \n" | 
 | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\ | 
 | Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands.")); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | 
 |  | 
 |   c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\ | 
 | Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\ | 
 | LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below)\n\ | 
 | or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\ | 
 | If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name.  With\n\ | 
 | no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\ | 
 | Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\ | 
 | This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\ | 
 | tracing library.  You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\ | 
 | by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\ | 
 | \n" LOCATION_SPEC_HELP_STRING "\n\n\ | 
 | Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\ | 
 | conditions are different.\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\ | 
 | Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands.")); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | 
 |  | 
 |   cmd_list_element *info_tracepoints_cmd | 
 |     = add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command, _("\ | 
 | Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\ | 
 | Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\ | 
 | last tracepoint set.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_info_alias ("tp", info_tracepoints_cmd, 1); | 
 |  | 
 |   cmd_list_element *delete_tracepoints_cmd | 
 |     = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\ | 
 | Delete specified tracepoints.\n\ | 
 | Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\ | 
 | No argument means delete all tracepoints."), | 
 | 	   &deletelist); | 
 |   add_alias_cmd ("tr", delete_tracepoints_cmd, class_trace, 1, &deletelist); | 
 |  | 
 |   c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\ | 
 | Disable specified tracepoints.\n\ | 
 | Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\ | 
 | No argument means disable all tracepoints."), | 
 | 	   &disablelist); | 
 |   deprecate_cmd (c, "disable"); | 
 |  | 
 |   c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\ | 
 | Enable specified tracepoints.\n\ | 
 | Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\ | 
 | No argument means enable all tracepoints."), | 
 | 	   &enablelist); | 
 |   deprecate_cmd (c, "enable"); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\ | 
 | Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\ | 
 | The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\ | 
 | Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\ | 
 | if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_basic_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, | 
 | 			_("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."), | 
 | 			&save_cmdlist, | 
 | 			0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist); | 
 |  | 
 |   c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\ | 
 | Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\ | 
 | This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\ | 
 | catchpoints, tracepoints).  Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\ | 
 | session to restore them."), | 
 | 	       &save_cmdlist); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer (c, deprecated_filename_completer); | 
 |  | 
 |   cmd_list_element *save_tracepoints_cmd | 
 |     = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\ | 
 | Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\ | 
 | Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."), | 
 | 	       &save_cmdlist); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer (save_tracepoints_cmd, deprecated_filename_completer); | 
 |  | 
 |   c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", save_tracepoints_cmd, class_trace, 0); | 
 |   deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints"); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_setshow_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, | 
 | 			  _("\ | 
 | Breakpoint specific settings.\n\ | 
 | Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\ | 
 | pending breakpoint behavior."), | 
 | 			  _("\ | 
 | Breakpoint specific settings.\n\ | 
 | Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\ | 
 | pending breakpoint behavior."), | 
 | 			  &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, | 
 | 			  &setlist, &showlist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class, | 
 | 				&pending_break_support, _("\ | 
 | Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\ | 
 | Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\ | 
 | If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\ | 
 | pending breakpoint.  If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\ | 
 | an error.  If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\ | 
 | user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."), | 
 | 				NULL, | 
 | 				show_pending_break_support, | 
 | 				&breakpoint_set_cmdlist, | 
 | 				&breakpoint_show_cmdlist); | 
 |  | 
 |   pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO; | 
 |  | 
 |   add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class, | 
 | 			   &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\ | 
 | Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\ | 
 | Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\ | 
 | If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\ | 
 | breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory.  If not set,\n\ | 
 | a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."), | 
 | 			   NULL, | 
 | 			   show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints, | 
 | 			   &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, | 
 | 			   &breakpoint_show_cmdlist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support, | 
 | 			   &always_inserted_mode, _("\ | 
 | Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\ | 
 | Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\ | 
 | When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\ | 
 | they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\ | 
 | only when the user deletes them.  When this mode is off (the default),\n\ | 
 | breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\ | 
 | when execution stops."), | 
 | 				NULL, | 
 | 				&show_always_inserted_mode, | 
 | 				&breakpoint_set_cmdlist, | 
 | 				&breakpoint_show_cmdlist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, | 
 | 			   &debug_breakpoint, _("\ | 
 | Set breakpoint location debugging."), _("\ | 
 | Show breakpoint location debugging."), _("\ | 
 | When on, breakpoint location specific debugging is enabled."), | 
 | 			   NULL, | 
 | 			   show_debug_breakpoint, | 
 | 			   &setdebuglist, &showdebuglist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint, | 
 | 			condition_evaluation_enums, | 
 | 			&condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\ | 
 | Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\ | 
 | Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\ | 
 | When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\ | 
 | evaluated on the host's side by GDB.  When it is set to \"target\",\n\ | 
 | breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\ | 
 | supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\ | 
 | If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\ | 
 | \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\ | 
 | be set to \"host\"."), | 
 | 			   &set_condition_evaluation_mode, | 
 | 			   &show_condition_evaluation_mode, | 
 | 			   &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, | 
 | 			   &breakpoint_show_cmdlist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\ | 
 | Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\ | 
 | break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\ | 
 | where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\ | 
 |   LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\ | 
 |   FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\ | 
 |   +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\ | 
 | 	   or the start of the range\n\ | 
 |   FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\ | 
 |   FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\ | 
 |   *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\ | 
 | \n\ | 
 | The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\ | 
 | an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\ | 
 | range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION).")); | 
 |  | 
 |   c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\ | 
 | Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\ | 
 | dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\ | 
 | location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n" | 
 | "\n" LOCATION_SPEC_HELP_STRING)); | 
 |   set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support, | 
 | 			dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\ | 
 | Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\ | 
 | Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\ | 
 | This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\ | 
 | If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\ | 
 | console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\ | 
 | If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\ | 
 | program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\ | 
 | output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."), | 
 | 			update_dprintf_commands, NULL, | 
 | 			&setlist, &showlist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support, | 
 | 			  &dprintf_function, _("\ | 
 | Set the function to use for dynamic printf."), _("\ | 
 | Show the function to use for dynamic printf."), NULL, | 
 | 			  update_dprintf_commands, NULL, | 
 | 			  &setlist, &showlist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support, | 
 | 			  &dprintf_channel, _("\ | 
 | Set the channel to use for dynamic printf."), _("\ | 
 | Show the channel to use for dynamic printf."), NULL, | 
 | 			  update_dprintf_commands, NULL, | 
 | 			  &setlist, &showlist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class, | 
 | 			   &disconnected_dprintf, _("\ | 
 | Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\ | 
 | Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\ | 
 | Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\ | 
 | even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."), | 
 | 			   NULL, | 
 | 			   NULL, | 
 | 			   &setlist, &showlist); | 
 |  | 
 |   add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\ | 
 | Target agent only formatted printing, like the C \"printf\" function.\n\ | 
 | Usage: agent-printf \"format string\", ARG1, ARG2, ARG3, ..., ARGN\n\ | 
 | This supports most C printf format specifications, like %s, %d, etc.\n\ | 
 | This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands.")); | 
 |  | 
 |   automatic_hardware_breakpoints = true; | 
 |  | 
 |   gdb::observers::about_to_proceed.attach (breakpoint_about_to_proceed, | 
 | 					   "breakpoint"); | 
 |   gdb::observers::thread_exit.attach (remove_threaded_breakpoints, | 
 | 				      "breakpoint"); | 
 |   gdb::observers::inferior_removed.attach (remove_inferior_breakpoints, | 
 | 					   "breakpoint"); | 
 | } |